AU737372C - Cell adhesion inhibitors - Google Patents

Cell adhesion inhibitors

Info

Publication number
AU737372C
AU737372C AU37386/97A AU3738697A AU737372C AU 737372 C AU737372 C AU 737372C AU 37386/97 A AU37386/97 A AU 37386/97A AU 3738697 A AU3738697 A AU 3738697A AU 737372 C AU737372 C AU 737372C
Authority
AU
Australia
Prior art keywords
sep
alkyl
group
aryl
heterocycle
Prior art date
Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
Ceased
Application number
AU37386/97A
Other versions
AU737372B2 (en
AU3738697A (en
Inventor
Steven P Adams
Carol L. Ensinger
Zhongli Zheng
Current Assignee (The listed assignees may be inaccurate. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of the list.)
Biogen MA Inc
Original Assignee
Biogen Idec MA Inc
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by Biogen Idec MA Inc filed Critical Biogen Idec MA Inc
Priority claimed from PCT/US1997/013013 external-priority patent/WO1998004247A1/en
Publication of AU3738697A publication Critical patent/AU3738697A/en
Application granted granted Critical
Publication of AU737372B2 publication Critical patent/AU737372B2/en
Priority to AU91330/01A priority Critical patent/AU759063B2/en
Publication of AU737372C publication Critical patent/AU737372C/en
Assigned to BIOGEN IDEC MA INC. reassignment BIOGEN IDEC MA INC. Request to Amend Deed and Register Assignors: BIOGEN, INC.
Anticipated expiration legal-status Critical
Ceased legal-status Critical Current

Links

Description


  
 



   CELL ADHESION INHIBITORS
 TECHNICAL FIELD OF THE INVENTION
 The present invention relates to novel compounds that are useful for inhibition, alteration, or prevention of cell adhesion and cell adhesion-mediated pathologies. This invention also relates to methods of identifying additional novel compounds having the desired activity, as well as to pharmaceutical formulations comprising these compounds, and methods of using them for inhibition and prevention of cell adhesion and cell adhesion-mediated pathologies. The compounds and pharmaceutical compositions of this invention can be used as therapeutic or prophylactic agents. They are particularly wellsuited for the treatment of many inflammatory and autoimmune diseases.



   BACKGROUND OF THE INVENTION
 Cell adhesion is a process by which cells associate with each other, migrate towards a specific target or localize within the extra-cellular matrix. As such, cell adhesion constitutes one of the fundamental mechanisms underlying  numerous biological phenomena. For example, cell adhesion is responsible for the adhesion of hematopoietic cells to endothelial cells and the subsequent migration of those hematopoietic cells out of blood vessels and to the site of inflammatory injury. As such, cell adhesion plays a role in numerous pathologies such as, for example, inflammation and immune reactions in mammals.



   Investigations into the molecular basis for cell adhesion have revealed that various cell-surface macromolecules -- collectively known as cell adhesion molecules or receptors -- mediate cell-cell and cell-matrix interactions.



  For example, proteins of the superfamily called   integrins'    are key mediators in adhesive interactions between hematopoietic cells and their micro environment (M.E. Hemler, "VLA Proteins in the Integrin Family: Structures, Functions, and Their Role on
Leukocytes.", Ann. Rev. Immunol., 8, p. 365 (1990)). Integrins are non-covalent heterodimeric complexes consisting of two subunits called a and   ss.    There are at least 16 different subunits (al-a9, a-L, a-M, a-D, a-X, aIIB, a-V and a-E) and at least 9 different   ss      (ssl-ss9)    subunits which have been identified to date. Based on the type of its a and   ss    subunit components, each integrin molecule can be categorized into a subfamily.



     a4ss1    integrin, also known as very late antigen of activation-4   ("VLA-4")    or CD49d/CD29, is a leukocyte cell surface receptor that participates in a wide variety of both cell-cell and cell-matrix adhesive interactions (M.E. Hemler,
Ann. Rev. Immunol., 8, p. 365 (1990)). It serves as a receptor for the cytokine-inducible endothelial cell surface protein, vascular cell adhesion   molecule      (VCAM-1"),    as well as to the  extracellular matrix protein fibronectin ("FN") (Ruegg et al.,
J. Cell Biol., 177, p. 179 (1991); Wayner et al., J. Cell Biol., 105, p. 1873 (1987); Kramer et al., J. Biol. Chem., 264, p. 4684
 (1989); Gehlsen et al. Science, 24, p. 1228 (1988)).

   Anti-VLA4 monoclonal antibodies ("mAb's") have been shown to inhibit VLA4dependent adhesive interactions both in vitro and in   vivo   
 (Ferguson et al. Proc.   Natl.    Acad. Sci., 88, p. 8072 (1991);
Ferguson et al., J. Immunol., 150, p. 1172 (1993)). Results of in vivo experiments suggest that the inhibition of VLA-4dependent cell adhesion may prevent, inhibit or alter several inflammatory and autoimmune pathologies. (R. L. Lobb et al., "The Pathophysiologic Role of a4 Integrins In Vivo", J. Clin.



  Invest., 94, pp. 1722-28 (1994)).



   Another integrin,   aIIbssIIIa    integrin   ("lIb/llIa"),    is the most abundant integrin found on the membrane surface of normal platelets. Jennings, et al., J.   Biol.    Chem., 257, p.



  10458 (1982). Platelets depend on the adhesive interactions of glycoproteins, such as "IIb8IIIa integrin, for proper function.



  J. Hawiger, Atherosclerosis Reviews, 21, pp. 165-86 (1990).



  Thus, inhibition of this interaction is one method of regulating platelet thrombus formation or aggregation. A variety of compounds are known to inhibit   aIIbssIIIa    integrins from binding to their natural ligands and thereby can regulate human disorders associated with a hyperthrombotic state.



  Compounds known to inhibit IIb/IIIa are described in the following patents and patent applications: GB 2 271 567 A; GB 2 292 558 A; EP 0 645 376 Al; EP 0 668 278 Al; EP 0 608 759 A2; EP 0 635 492 Al; WO 94/22820; US 5,340,798 and WO 94/09029; US 5,256,812, EP 0 381 033 and US 5,084,466; WO 94/18981; WO  94/01396 and US 5,272,162; WO 94/21602; WO 94/22444; WO 94/29273; WO 95/18111; WO 95/18619; WO 95/25091; WO 94/18162, US 5,220,050 and WO 93/16038; US 4,879,313 and EP 0 352 249 B1; WO 93/16697, US 5,227,490, EP 0 478 363 A2, US 5,229,616 and WO 94/12181; US 5,258,398 and WO 93/11759; WO 93/08181 and EP 0 537 980 Al; WO 93/09133; EP 0 530 505 B1; EP 0 566 919 A1; EP 0 540 334 B1; EP 0 560 730 A2; WO 93/10091, EP 0 542 363 A2 and WO 93/14077; EP 0 505 868 B1; EP 0 614 664 Al; US 5,358,956; US 5,334,596 and WO 94/26745; WO 94/12478; WO 94/14776; WO 93/00095;

   WO 93/18058, WO 93/07867, US 5,239,113, US 5,344,957 and EP 0 542 708 Al; WO 94/22825; US 5,250,679 and WO 93/08174;
US 5,084,466; EP 0 668 278 Al; US 5,264,420; WO 94/08962; EP   0    529 858; US 5,389,631; WO 94/08577; EP 0 632 016; EP 0 503 548;
EP 0 512 831 and WO 92/19595; WO 93/22303; EP 0 525 629; EP   0    604 800; EP 0 587 134; EP 0 623 615; EP 0 655 439; US 5,446,056 and WO 95/14682; US 5,399,585; WO 93/12074; EP 0 512 829; EP   0    372 486 and US 5,039,805; EP 0 632 020 and US 5,494,922; US 5,403,836; WO 94/22834; WO 94/21599; EP 0 478 328;

   WO 94/17034
WO 96/20192, WO 96/19223, WO 96/19221, WO 96/19222, EP 727425,
EP 478362, EP 478363, US 5,272,158, US 5,227,490, US 5,294,616,
US 5,334,596, EP 645376, EP 711770, US 5,314,902, WO 94/00424,
US 5,523,302, EP 718287, DE 4446301, WO 96/22288, WO 96/29309,
EP 719775, EP 635492, WO 96/16947, US 5,602,155, WO 96/38426, EP 712844, US 5,292,756, WO 96/37482, WO 96/38416, WO 96/41803, WO 97/11940
 Each of these references is specifically incorporated herein in its entirety.



   In order to identify the minimum active amino acid sequence necessary to bind VLA-4, Komoriya et al. synthesized a variety  of overlapping peptides based on the amino acid sequence of the
CS-1 region (the VLA-4 binding domain) of a particular species of fibronectin.   ("The    Minimal Essential Sequence for a Major
Cell Type-Specific Adhesion Site   (CS1)    Within the Alternatively
Spliced Type III Connecting Segment Domain of Fibronectin Is
Leucine-Aspartic Acid-Valine", J.   Biol.    Chem., 266 (23), pp. 15075-79 (1991)). They identified an 8-amino acid peptide,
Glu-Ile-Leu-Asp-Val-Pro-Ser-Thr, as well as two smaller overlapping pentapeptides, Glu-Ile-Leu-Asp-Val and Leu-Asp-Val
Pro-Ser, that possessed inhibitory activity against FN-dependent cell adhesion.

   These results suggested that the tripeptide Leu
Asp-Val was the minimum sequence for cell-adhesion activity. It was later shown that Leu-Asp-Val binds only to lymphocytes that express an activated form of VLA-4, thus casting doubt on the utility of such a peptide in vivo (E.A. Wayner et al., "Activation-Dependent Recognition by Hematopoietic Cells of the
LDV Sequence in the V Region of Fibronectin", J. Cell. Biol., 116(2), pp. 489-497 (1992)). However, certain larger peptides containing the LDV sequence were subsequently shown to be active in vivo (T. A. Ferguson et al., "Two Integrin Binding Peptides
Abrogate T-cell-Mediated Immune Responses In   Viva",    Proc.   Natl.   



  Acad.   Sci.    USA, 88, pp. 8072-76 (1991); and S. M. Wahl et al., "Synthetic Fibronectin Peptides Suppress Arthritis in Rats by
Interrupting Leukocyte Adhesion and Recruitment", J. Clin.



  Invest., 94, pp. 655-62 (1994)).



   A cyclic pentapeptide, Arg-Cys-Asp-TPro-Cys
 (wherein TPro denotes 4-thioproline), which can inhibit both
VLA-4 and VLA-5 adhesion to FN has also been described. (See, e.g., D.M. Nowlin et al. "A Novel Cyclic Pentapeptide Inhibits    a4pl    and   a51    Integrin-mediated Cell Adhesion", J. Biol. Chem., 268(27), pp. 20352-59 (1993); and PCT publication   PCT/US91/04862).    This pentapeptide was based on the tripeptide sequence Arg-Gly-Asp from FN which had been known as a common motif in the recognition site for several extracellular-matrix proteins.



   Examples of other VLA-4 inhibitors have been reported, for example, in copending United States patent application 08/376,372, specifically incorporated by reference herein. USSN 376,372 describes linear peptidyl compounds containing b-amino acids which have cell adhesion inhibitory activity.



  International patent applications WO 94/15958 and WO 92/00995, specifically incorporated by reference, describe cyclic peptide and peptidomimetic compounds with cell adhesion inhibitory activity. International patent applications WO 93/08823 and WO 92/08464 (specifically incorporated by reference herein) describe guanidinyl-, urea- and thiourea-containing cell adhesion inhibitory compounds. United States Patent No.



  5,260,277 describes guanidinyl cell adhesion modulation compounds, and is also specifically incorporated herein.



   Despite these advances, there remains a need for small, potent inhibitors of cell adhesion, particularly for potent inhibitors of VLA-4 or IIb/IIIa cell adhesion. Ideally, such inhibitors would be small so that they may be administered orally. Such compounds would provide useful agents for treatment, alteration, prevention or suppression of various pathologies mediated by cell adhesion and VLA-4 or IIb/IIIa binding.  



   SUMMARY OF THE INVENTION
 The present invention solves this problem by providing novel compounds that inhibit cell adhesion, and, specifically, the binding of ligands to VLA-4. These compounds are useful for inhibition, prevention and suppression of VLA-4-mediated cell adhesion, and pathologies associated with that adhesion, such as inflammation and immune reactions. The compounds of this invention may be used alone or in combination with other therapeutic or prophylactic agents to inhibit, alter, prevent or suppress cell adhesion.



   The present invention thus provides novel compounds, formulations and methods which may be used in the study, diagnosis, treatment or prevention of diseases and conditions which relate to cell adhesion, including, but not limited to arthritis, asthma, allergies, adult respiratory distress syndrome, cardiovascular disease, thrombosis or harmful platelet aggregation, allograft rejection, neoplastic disease, psoriasis, multiple sclerosis, CNS inflammation, Crohn's disease, ulcerative colitis, glomerular nephritis and related inflammatory renal disease, diabetes, ocular inflammation (such as uveitis), atherosclerosis, inflammatory and autoimmune diseases. This invention also provides pharmaceutical formulations containing these VLA-4-mediated cell adhesion inhibitors and methods of using the compounds and compositions of the invention for inhibition of cell adhesion.



   According to one embodiment of this invention, these novel compounds, compositions and methods are advantageously used to treat inflammatory and immune diseases. The present  invention also provides methods for preparing the compounds of this invention and intermediates useful in those methods.



   Accordingly, the present invention relates to cell adhesion inhibitors comprising a compound having Formula(I)
 A-B (I) where A comprises a specificity determinant which does not impart significant IIb/IIIa activity, and B comprises an integrin scaffold. More specifically, the present invention relates to a compound of Formula (I) having VLA-4 inhibitory activity and an integrin scaffold derived from a compound having
IIb/IIIa activity.



   In other embodiments, the claimed invention relates to preferred VLA-4 inhibitors wherein B is chosen from the integrin scaffolds of the compounds set forth in Table 2, or more preferably, from the scaffolds identified in the compounds in
Table 1. Further, most preferred compounds are those in table 3, and preferred scaffolds, as well as preferred specificity determinants, are those derived from the compounds exemplified in Tables 1, 2 and 3.



   Additionally, the present invention relates to methods of making cell adhesion inhibitors, generally, by removing the
IIb/IIIa specificity determinant from a IIb/IIIa inhibitor, and replacing said specificity determinant with a VLA-4 specificity determinant, thereby creating a novel, heretofore undescribed,
VLA-4 inhibitor.



   More specifically, the methods of making the cell adhesion inhibitors of the invention comprise the steps of providing a first compound having IIb/IIIa inhibitory activity. The first compound comprises a IIB/IIIa specificity determinant,  comprising a basic nitrogen functionality, which, for example, may be a phenylamidine moiety, and an integrin scaffold. One removes the phenylamidine moiety, or, if none is present, as for example, when the nitrogen functionality is a piperidine or a benzylamine, creating a   phantom"    phenylamidine moiety by creating phantom bonds in the para orientation, and removing unneeded bonds, as discussed in more detail below, and removing the "phantom" moiety.

   The phenylamidine moiety is then replaced with a VLA-4 specificity determinant, thereby creating a second compound, having VLA-4 specificity determinant and an integrin scaffold, and having VLA-4 activity. In certain embodiments, it may be preferable to insert an additional group at the point of, or adjacent to, the connection between the integrin scaffold and the specificity determinant, to confer desirable characteristics on the compound. Such desirable characteristics are easily determined by those skilled in the art, and may, for example, encompass such characteristics as flexibility, or structural modifications designed to alter the activities of the compound.



  Any suitable additional groups may be used, and are known by those skilled in the art. Preferred groups may include, but are not limited to carbonyl, carboxamide, ether, nitrogen, oxygen, sulfide, sulfur amide, and methylene.



   In yet other embodiments, the method described above can be used to make a pharmaceutical composition for the treatment of a condition associated with cell adhesion. The methods described above for making VLA-4 inhibitors are followed, and then suitable pharmaceutically acceptable carriers, excipients, additives, stabilizers etc. may be added. The claimed invention also encompasses "cocktail" compositions, i.e. those containing  the compounds of the invention in addition to other active reagents. Such compositions are discussed in more detail below.



   Certain embodiments encompass methods of treating cell adhesion associated conditions in mammals by administering a therapeutically effective amount of a composition. The claimed methods of treatment are most appropriate for humans, although other mammals are also suitable subjects.



  Advantageously, because of the relatively small size of the compounds of the invention, the compositions are particularly suitable for oral administration in the form of a solid, liquid or suspension.



   Additional features and advantages of the invention will be set forth in the description which follows, and in part will be apparent from the description, or may be learned by practice of the invention. The objectives and other advantages of the invention will be realized and attained by the methods and compositions particularly pointed out in the written description and claims hereof.  



  DETAILED DESCRIPTION OF THE INVENTION
A. Definitions
 The following abbreviations are used in the description:
 Designation Reagent or Fragment
 Ac acetyl
 Bn benzyl
 Boc tert-butoxycarbonyl
 Bu butyl
 Cbz carbobenzyloxy
 Cy cyclohexyl
 CyM cyclohexylmethyl
   DI PEA    diisopropylethylamine
 EDC   1- (3-diethylaminopropyl) -3-       ethyl carbodi imide   
 HOBT l-hydroxybenzotriazole hydrate
   I-amyl    isoamyl
 I-Pn isopentyl
 I-Pr isopropyl
 Me methyl
 2-MPUBA 4-(N=-(2-methylphenyl)urea)
 phenylmethylamino
 2-MPUPA 4-(N=-(2-methylphenyl)urea)
 phenylacetyl
 NMP   N-methylpyrrol idinone   
 NMM N-methylmorpholine
 Ph phenyl
 PUPA 4-(N=-phenylurea)phenylacetyl
 Su succinimidyl
 TBTU   2- (lH-benzotriazol-l-yl) -   
 1,1,3,

  3-tetramethyluronium
 tetrafluoroborate
 TEA triethylamine
 TFA trifluoroacetic acid
 THAM   tris(hydroxy)methylaminomethane     
Definitions
 As used herein, the term   "alkyl",    alone or in combination, refers to a straight-chain or branched-chain alkyl radical containing from 1 to 10, preferably from 1 to 6 and more preferably from 1 to 4, carbon atoms. Examples of such radicals include, but are not limited to, methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, isobutyl, sec-butyl, tert-butyl, pentyl, iso-amyl, hexyl, decyl and the like.



   The term "alkenyl", alone or in combination, refers to a straight-chain or branched-chain alkenyl radical containing from 2 to 10, preferably from 2 to 6 and more preferably from 2 to 4, carbon atoms. Examples of such radicals include, but are not limited to, ethenyl, E- and Z-propenyl, isopropenyl, E- and
Z-butenyl, E- and Z-isobutenyl, E- and Z-pentenyl, decenyl and the like.



   The term "alkynyl", alone or in combination, refers to a straight-chain or branched-chain alkynyl radical containing from 2 to 10, preferably from 2 to 6 and more preferably from 2 to 4, carbon atoms. Examples of such radicals include, but are not limited to, ethynyl (acetylenyl), propynyl, propargyl, butynyl, hexynyl, decynyl and the like.



   The term "cycloalkyl", alone or in combination, refers to a cyclic alkyl radical containing from 3-12, preferably from 3-8 and more preferably from 3-6, carbon atoms and may be optionally aryl-fused. Examples of such radicals include, but are not limited to, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl and the like.



   The term "cycloalkenyl", alone or in combination, refers to a cyclic carbocycle containing from 4 to 8, preferably  5 or 6, carbon atoms and one or more double bonds. Examples of such cycloalkenyl radicals include, but are not limited to, cyclopentenyl, cyclohexenyl, cyclopentadienyl and the like.



   The term "aryl" refers to a carbocyclic aromatic group selected from the group consisting of phenyl, naphthyl, indenyl, indanyl, azulenyl, fluorenyl, and anthracenyl; or a heterocyclic aromatic group selected from the group consisting of furyl, thienyl, pyridyl, pyrrolyl, oxazolyly, thiazolyl, imidazolyl, pyrazolyl, 2-pyrazolinyl, pyrazolidinyl, isoxazolyl, isothiazolyl, 1,2,3-oxadiazolyl, 1,2,3-triazolyl, 1,3,4thiadiazolyl, pyridazinyl, pyrimidinyl, pyrazinyl, 1,3,5triazinyl, 1,3,5-trithianyl, indolizinyl, indolyl, isoindolyl, 3H-indolyl, indolinyl, benzo[b]furanyl, 2,3-dihydrobenzofuranyl,   benzo[b]thiophenyl,      lH-indazolyl,    benzimidazolyl, benzthiazolyl, purinyl, 4H-quinolizinyl, quinolinyl, isoquinolinyl, cinnolinyl, phthalazinyl, quinazolinyl, quinoxalinyl, 1,8-naphthyridinyl, pteridinyl, carbazolyl, acridinyl, phenazinyl,

   phenothiazinyl, phenoxazinyl,   pyrazolo [1,5-c] triazinyl    and the like.



   "Aryl", "Acycloalkyl" and "Acycloalkenyl" "Groups", as defined in this application may independently contain up to three substituents which are independently selected from the group consisting of halogen, hydroxyl, amino, nitro, trifluoromethyl, trifluoromethoxy, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cyano, carboxy, carboalkoxy, Ar'-substituted alkyl, Ar'substituted alkenyl or alkynyl, 1,2-dioxymethylene, 1,2dioxyethylene, alkoxy, alkenoxy or alkynoxy, Ar'-substituted alkoxy, Ar'-substituted alkenoxy or alkynoxy, alkylamino, alkenylamino or alkynylamino, Ar'-substituted alkylamino, Ar'substituted alkenylamino or alkynylamino, Ar' -substituted  carbonyloxy, alkylcarbonyloxy, aliphatic or aromatic acyl, Ar'substituted acyl, Ar'-substituted alkylcarbonyloxy, Ar'substituted carbonylamino, Ar'-substituted amino, Ar'substituted oxy, Ar'-substituted carbonyl, alkylcarbonylamino,

  
Ar'-substituted alkylcarbonylamino, alkoxy-carbonylamino,   Ar' -    substituted alkoxycarbonyl-amino,   Ar' -oxycarbonylamino,    alkylsulfonylamino, mono- or   bis- (Ar' -sulfonyl) amino,      Ar' -    substituted alkyl-sulfonylamino, morpholinocarbonylamino, thiomorpholinocarbonylamino, N-alkyl guanidino, N-Ar' guanidino,   N-N-(Ar',alkyl)    guanidino, N,N-(Ar',Ar')guanidino, N,N-dialkyl guanidino, N,N,N-trialkyl guanidino, N-alkyl urea, N,N-dialkyl urea, N-Ar' urea, N,N-(Ar',alkyl) urea,   N,N-(Ar')2    urea, aralkyloxycarbonyl -substituted alkyl, aralkylaminocarbonyl, thioaryloxy and the like;

   wherein "Ar'" is analogous to aryl, but contains up to three substituents selected from the group consisting of halogen, hydroxyl, amino, nitro, trifluoromethyl, trifluoromethoxy, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, 1,2-dioxymethylene, 1,2-dioxyethylene, alkoxy, alkenoxy, alkynoxy, alkylamino, alkenylamino or alkynylamino, alkylcarbonyloxy, aliphatic or aromatic acyl, alkylcarbonylamino, alkoxycarbonylamino, alkylsulfonylamino, N-alkyl or N,N-dialkyl urea.



   The term "aralkyl", alone or in combination, refers to an aryl substituted alkyl radical, wherein the term "alkyl" and "aryl" are as defined above. Examples of suitable aralkyl radicals include, but are not limited to, phenylmethyl, phenethyl, phenylhexyl, diphenylmethyl, pyridylmethyl, tetrazolylmethyl, furylmethyl, imidazolyl-methyl, indolylmethyl, thienylpropyl and the like.  



   The term   "alkoxy",    alone or in combination, refers to an alkyl ether radical, wherein the term "alkyl" is as defined above. Examples of suitable alkyl ether radicals include, but are not limited to, methoxy, ethoxy, n-propoxy, iso-propoxy, nbutoxy, iso-butoxy, sec-butoxy, tert-butoxy and the like.



   The term "alkenoxy", alone or in combination, refers to a radical of formula alkenyl-O-, wherein the term "alkenyl" is as defined above provided that the radical is not an enol ether. Examples of suitable alkenoxy radicals include, but are not limited to, allyloxy, E- and Z-3-methyl-2-propenoxy and the like. The term   "alkynyloxy",    alone or in combination, refers to a radical of formula alkynyl-O-, wherein the term "alkynyl" is as defined above, provided that the radical is not an -ynol ether. Examples of suitable alkynoxy radicals include, but are not limited to, propargyloxy, 2-butynyloxy and the like.



   The term "thioalkoxy" refers to a thioether radical of formula alkyl-S-, wherein alkyl is as defined above.



   The term "alkylamino", alone or in combination with other substituents, refers to a mono- or di-alkyl-substituted amino radical (i.e., a radical of formula alkyl-NH- or (alkyl)2
N-), wherein the term "alkyl" is as defined above. Examples of suitable alkylamino radicals include, but are not limited to, methylamino, ethylamino, propylamino, isopropylamino, tbutylamino, N,N-diethylamino and the like.



   The term "alkenylamino", alone or in combination, refers to a radical of formula alkenyl-NH- or (alkenyl)2N-, wherein the term "alkenyl" is as defined above, provided that the radical is not an enamine. An example of such alkenylamino radicals is the allylamino radical.  



   The term "alkynylamino", alone or in combination, refers to a radical of formula alkynyl-NH- or (alkynyl)2N-, wherein the term "alkynyl" is as defined above, provided that the radical is not an amine. An example of such alkynylamino radicals is the propargyl amino radical.



   The term "aryloxy", alone or in combination, refers to a radical of formula aryl-O-, wherein aryl is as defined above.



  Examples of aryloxy radicals include, but are not limited to, phenoxy, naphthoxy, pyridyloxy and the like.



   The term "arylamino", alone or in combination, refers to a radical of formula aryl-NH-, wherein aryl is as defined above. Examples of arylamino radicals include, but are not limited to, phenylamino (anilido), naphthylamino, 2-, 3- and 4pyridylamino and the like.



   The term "biaryl", alone or in combination, refers to a radical of formula aryl-aryl-, wherein the term "aryl" is as defined above.



   The term "thioaryl", alone or in combination, refers to a radical of formula aryl-S-, wherein the term   "aryl1,    is as defined above. An example of a thioaryl radical is the thiophenyl radical.



   The term   "aryl-f used    cycloalkyl", alone or in combination, refers to a cycloalkyl radical which shares two adjacent atoms with an aryl radical, wherein the terms "cycloalkyl" and "aryl" are as defined above. An example of an aryl-fused cycloalkyl radical is the benzo-fused cyclobutyl radical.



   The term "aliphatic   acyl",    alone or in combination, refers to radicals of formula alkyl-CO-, alkenyl-CO- and  alkynyl-CO-derived from an alkane-, alkene- or alkyncarboxylic acid, wherein the terms   "alkyl",    "alkenyl" and "alkynyl" are as defined above. Examples of such aliphatic acyl radicals include, but are not limited to, acetyl, propionyl, butyryl, valeryl, 4-methylvaleryl, acryloyl, crotyl, propiolyl, methylpropiolyl and the like.



   The terms "aromatic acyl" or   flaroylli1    alone or in combination, refers to a radical of formula aryl-CO-, wherein the term "aryl" is as defined above. Examples of suitable aromatic acyl radicals include, but are not limited to, benzoyl, 4-halobenzoyl, 4-carboxybenzoyl, naphthoyl, pyridylcarbonyl and the like.



   The term "heterocycloyl", alone or in combination, refers to radicals of formula heterocycle-CO-, wherein the term "heterocycle" is as defined below. Examples of suitable heterocycloyl radicals include but are not limited to, tetrahydrofuranylcarbonyl, piperidinylcarbonyl, tetrahydrothiophenecarbonyl and the like.



   The terms "morpholinocarbonyl" and   "thiomorpholinocarbonyl",    alone or in combination with other terms, refer to an N-carbonylated morpholino and an Ncarbonylated thiomorpholino radical, respectively.



   The term "alkylcarbonylamino", alone or in combination, refers to a radical of formula alkyl-CONH, wherein the term "alkyl" is as defined above.



   The term "alkoxycarbonylamino", alone or in combination, refers to a radical of formula alkyl-OCONH-, wherein the term "alkyl" is as defined above.  



   The term "alkylsulfonylamino", alone or in combination, refers to a radical of formula alkyl-SO2NH-, wherein the term "alkyl" is as defined above.



   The term "arylsulfonylamino", alone or in combination, refers to a radical of formula aryl-SO2NH-, wherein the term "aryl" is as defined above.



   The term "N-alkylurea", alone or in combination, refers to a radical of formula alkyl-NH-CO-NH-, wherein the term "alkyl" is as defined above.



   The term "N-arylurea", alone or in combination, refers to a radical of formula aryl-NH-CO-NH-, wherein the term "aryl" is as defined above.



   The term "halogen" means fluorine, chlorine, bromine and iodine.



   The terms "heterocycle" and "heterocyclic   ring",    alone or in combination, refer to a non-aromatic 3- to l0-membered ring containing at least one endocyclic N, O or S atom. The heterocycle may optionally be   aryl-f used.    The heterocycle may also be optionally substituted with one to three substituents which are independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, hydroxyl, amino, nitro, trifluoromethyl, trifluoromethoxy, alkyl, aralkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, cyano, carboxy, carboalkoxy, Ar'-substituted alkyl, Ar'-substituted alkenyl or alkynyl,   1,2-dioxymethylene,    1,2-dioxyethylene, alkoxy, alkenoxy or alkynoxy, Ar'-substituted alkoxy, Ar'substituted alkenoxy or alkynoxy, alkylamino, alkenylamino or alkynylamino, Ar' -substituted alkylamino, Ar' -substituted alkenylamino or alkynylamino,

   Ar'-substituted carbonyloxy, alkylcarbonyloxy, aliphatic or aromatic acyl, Ar'-substituted  acyl, Ar' -substituted alkylcarbonyloxy, Ar' -substituted carbonylamino, Ar' -substituted amino, Ar'-substituted oxy, Ar'substituted carbonyl, alkylcarbonylamino, Ar' -substituted alkylcarbonylamino, alkoxy-carbonylamino, Ar'-substituted alkoxycarbonyl-amino,   Ar' -oxycarbonylamino,    alkylsulfonylamino, mono- or bis-(Ar'-sulfonyl)amino, Ar' -substituted alkyl  sul fonylamino,    morpholinocarbonylamino, thiomorpholinocarbonylamino, N-alkyl guanidino, N-Ar' guanidino,   N-N-(Ar',alkyl)    guanidino, N,N-(Ar',Ar')guanidino, N,N-dialkyl guanidino, N,N,N-trialkyl guanidino, N-alkyl urea, N,N-dialkyl urea, N-Ar' urea, N,N-(Ar',alkyl) urea, N,N-(Ar')2 urea, aralkoxycarbonyl-substituted alkyl, carboxyalkyl, oxo, 

   arylsulfonyl and aralkylaminocarbonyl.



   The term  <RTI   ID 



   The terms "activated derivative of a suitably protected "-amino acid" and "activated substituted-phenylacetic acid derivative" refer to derivatives of carboxylic acids wherein the -OH group is replaced by a superior leaving group.



  Examples of activated acid derivatives include, but are not limited to, the corresponding acyl halides (e.g. acid fluoride, acid chloride and acid bromide), corresponding activated esters
 (e.g. nitrophenyl ester, the ester of 1-hydroxybenzotriazole,
HOBT, or the ester of hydroxysuccinimide, HOSu), and other conventional derivatives within the skill of the art.



   The term "amino acid side chain(s)" refers to the side chain attached to the a-carbon of an amino acid. Examples of amino acid side chains include, but are not limited to, methyl, isopropyl, benzyl and carboxymethyl for alanine, valine, phenylalinine and aspartic acid, respectively.



   The terms "protected or protecting group" refer to a suitable chemical group which may be attached to a functional group of a molecule, then removed at a later stage to reveal the intact functional group and molecule. Examples of suitable protecting groups for various functional groups are described in
T.W. Greene and P.G.M. Wuts, Protective Groups in Organic
Synthesis, 2d. Ed., John Wiley and Sons (1991); L. Fieser and M.



  Fieser, Fieser and Fieser=s Reagents for Organic Synthesis, John
Wiley and Sons (1994); L. Paquette, ed. Encyclopedia of Reagents for Organic Synthesis, John Wiley and Sons (1995).



   The compounds of this invention may contain one or more asymmetric carbon atoms and thus occur as racemates and racemic mixtures, single enantiomers, diastereomeric mixtures and individual diastereomers. All such isomeric forms of these  compounds are expressly included in the present invention. Each stereogenic carbon may be of the R or S configuration. Although the specific compounds exemplified in this application may be depicted in a particular stereochemical configuration, compounds having either the opposite stereochemistry at any given chiral center or mixtures thereof are envisioned as part of the invention. Although amino acids and amino acid side chains may be depicted in a particular configuration, both natural and unnatural forms are envisioned as part of the invention.



   In view of the above definitions, other chemical terms used throughout this application can be easily understood by those of skill in the art. Terms may be used alone or in any combination thereof. The preferred and more preferred chain lengths of the radicals apply to all such combinations.



  B. Description
 The compounds of this invention result from the discoveries that existing IIb/IIIa integrin inhibitory compounds may be converted into VLA-4 inhibitory compounds, and IIb/IIIa inhibitory compounds can be made by combining a unique VLA-4 integrin scaffold with a IIb/IIIa specificity determinant. Known
IIb/IIIa inhibitors can be described structurally as comprising a "specificity determinant" and an "integrin scaffold". A "specificity determinant" is that portion of a compound which confers on said compound a desired selectivity towards a binding partner. The "integrin scaffold" is the remaining portion of said compound. Thus for example, a typical IIb/IIIa specificity determinant may contain a basic nitrogen functionality, and the  integrin scaffold may denote the part with an acidic functionality.



   Thus, for example, the novel compounds of the invention encompass compounds of the formula (I)
 A-B (I) wherein A is a specificity determinant and B is an integrin scaffold. More specifically, for purposes of the present invention, the compound of Formula (I) has VLA-4 inhibitory activity, and, A comprises a specificity determinant which does not impart significant IIb/IIIa activity to the compound, and B is derived from a IIb/IIIa inhibitor. As used herein, the terms "significant activity" means having an IC50 value less than about   50M.   



   VLA-4 inhibitors   comprising    a VLA-4 specificity determinant and a IIb/IIIa scaffold.



   In a preferred embodiment, the compound of formula (I)is a
VLA-4 inhibitor wherein A is a VLA-4 specificity determinant which does not impart significant IIB/IIIa activity, and B is an integrin scaffold derived from a molecule having IIb/IIIa activity. In a more preferred embodiment, B is an integrin scaffold derived from any one of the IIb/IIIa inhibitors described in Table 2. However, it is to be understood that based upon applicants invention, and using the claimed methods, virtually any compound which has IIb/IIIa activity can be converted into a VLA-4 inhibitor by removing the IIb/IIIa specificity determinant and replacing it with a VLA-4  specificity determinant. Methods of conversion are explained in more detail below.



   Surprisingly, when an integrin scaffold from a
IIb/IIIa inhibitor is attached to a VLA-4 specificity determinant, a compound with VLA-4 inhibitory activity is formed. Moreover, the resulting VLA-4 inhibitors, as a class, do not demonstrate any significant IIb/IIIa inhibitory activity relative to the IIb/IIIa inhibitors from which the scaffold is derived. Thus, this invention provides VLA-4 inhibitors comprising any integrin scaffold derived from a compound having
IIb/IIIa inhibitory activity, and any VLA-4 specificity determinant.



   The claimed invention also encompasses methods of making these compounds having cell adhesion inhibitory activity, more preferably, VLA-4 inhibitory activity. Additionally disclosed herein are methods of making pharmaceutical compositions comprising these compounds, as well as methods of treatment using them.



   Applicants provide herein methods of identifying compounds having IIb/IIIa inhibitory activity, and methods of identifying compounds having VLA-4 inhibitory activity. Furthermore, applicants describe methods of identifying the "scaffold" on any compound having IIb/IIIa activity, and methods of identifying the specificity determinant on any compound having VLA-4 inhibitory activity. Additionally disclosed are methods of combining the "scaffold" with a VLA-4 specificity determined to create a novel VLA-4 inhibitor.



   Methods of Converting compounds having IIb/IIIa inhibitory activity to novel compounds having VLA-4 inhibitory activity  
 In general, the present invention provides methods of converting compounds which have IIb/IIIa inhibitory activity into novel compounds having VLA-4 inhibitory activity and do not retain significant IIb/IIIa activity. Generally, the methods involve identifying an integrin scaffold in a IIb/IIIa inhibitor, and identifying a VLA-4 specificity determinant. The specificity determinant is that portion of the compound which imparts the binding activity on the molecule. Once these structures are identified, one can combine the IIb/IIIa integrin scaffold with the specificity determinant from a compound having
VLA-4 inhibitory activity, and obtain a new VLA-4 inhibitor.



   In a basic embodiment, therefore, one skilled in the art first identifies a compound having IIb/IIIa inhibitory activity.



  Compounds having IIb/IIIa inhibitory activity are well known to those skilled in the art, and are readily available, see, e.g.,
Table 2 and the references incorporated herein in the Background of the Invention. For purposes of this invention, one skilled in the art may use any of these known compounds. Alternatively, one may determine in assays known to those skilled in the art whether a particular compound has IIB/IIIa activity. If the assay is positive, then the scaffold will be useful in the present invention. Assays for IIb/IIIa inhibitory activity are well known in the art. Thus, for example, IIb/IIIa activity can be demonstrated by assessing the ability of compounds to inhibit the binding of the IIb/IIIa receptor to, for example, a known
IIb/IIIa ligand, like fibrinogen or fibronectin, or, alternatively, to a known antagonist.

   (W093/00095, specifically incorporated herein by reference.) Additionally, the  aforementioned binding to ligands can be assessed by one skilled in the art in a platelet aggregation assay.



   Many of the existing gp IIB/IIIa inhibitors contain a specificity determinant which compromises a phenylamidine moiety, which, for purposes of the invention, can serve as a point of orientation for conversion of said IIb/IIIa inhibitor to a VLA-4 inhibitor. In inhibitors which do not have a phenylamidine moiety, the existing basic functionality is converted to a "phantom" phenylamidine moiety, as explained in further detail below. Thus, according to the teachings herein, one can convert virtually any compound having IIb/IIIa activity to a VLA-4 inhibitor by replacing the IIB/IIIa specificity determinant.



   The following teaching will enable one skilled in the art to make a claimed VLA-4 inhibitor, using as a starting material any compound which has IIb/IIIa inhibitory activity. Thus, based on the teaching below, one can take the chemical structure of any IIb/IIIa compound, and predict the structure of a compound having VLA-4 inhibitory activity. Applicants have successfully applied this teaching to numerous compounds, and determined that the compounds identified in this manner do in fact have VLA-4 inhibitory activity.  



  Teachina I:
 In certain embodiments, the artisan identifies the chemical structure of a compound having IIb/IIIa activity, such as, for example, the following:
EMI26.1     

 As discussed above, in order to convert this   lib/Illa    structure into a structure which has VLA-4 inhibitory activity, one must replace the IIb/IIIa specificity determinant with a VLA-4 specificity determinant.



   Known IIb/IIIa inhibitors frequently have specificity determinants comprising a phenylamidine moiety or other basic functionality. Thus, for example, in the IIb/IIIa inhibitor above (US 5,239,113, claimed herein by reference), the specificity determinant comprises a phenylamidine moiety. To convert this compound to a VLA-4 inhibitory compound, the phenylamidine is "removed" and a VLA-4 specificity determinant is appended.



   In the first step of this conversion, for example, the phenyl ring of the phenylamidine moiety in the above compound can be taken to be the inner phenyl ring of a diphenyl urea. In the second step, the amidine functionality is removed and the remainder of the urea is appended. In this example, the bond of connection between the specificity determinant and the integrin scaffold is the amide bond next to the inner phenyl ring of the urea. The steps of this teaching are not limited to amidine-bearing phenyl rings. They can  be applied in a likewise manner to, for example piperazine and piperidine rings bearing amidine functionality.
EMI27.1     




   The compound created via this teaching is a new compound having VLA-4 inhibitory activity. It generally consists of the integrin scaffold of a IIb/IIIa inhibitor and a VLA-4 specificity determinant, i.e. a urea. This compound does not have significant   IIb/IIIa    inhibitory activity.



  Teachina II:
 Not all IIb/IIIa inhibitors have a phenylamidine moiety.



  Thus, to convert a IIb/IIIa compound without a phenylamidine moiety to a VLA-4 inhibitor, the basic functionality can be used as point of reference. For example, in the IIb/IIIa inhibitor below (WO 92/19595, claimed herein by reference), the artisan would use the basic functionality, i.e. the piperidine nitrogen, of the specificity determinant as a point of reference to create1 theoretically, a "phantom" phenylamidine.
EMI27.2     
  



   This is done by drawing "phantom" bonds between the 3-position of the piperidine and the carbon alpha to the lactam nitrogen. The "phantom" bonds are shown dashed in the structure below. The orientation of the groups on the "phantom" ring is preferably para.
EMI28.1     




   The second step in creating this "phantom" phenylamidine is to remove the unnecessary bonds and atoms to generate a structure having a "phantom" para-substituted phenylamidine, as shown below.
EMI28.2     




   Third, since the "phantom" specificity determinant is comprised of a phenylamidine moiety, the structure of a compound having VLA-4 activity can be drawn following the steps of Teaching
I. In this example, the bond of connection between the specificity determinant and the integrin scaffold is that connecting the inner phenyl ring of the urea to the lactam nitrogen.  
EMI29.1     




  Teachlna III:
 In other embodiments the original IIb/IIIa compound may have a specificity determinant comprising a guanidine group. As in
Teaching   II,    the basic functionality can be used as a point of reference for converting the IIb/IIIa inhibitor to a VLA-4 inhibitor.
EMI29.2     




   In the structure above (WO 93/08174, claimed herein by reference), the "phantom" phenylamidine is constructed from the internal guanidine nitrogen and the carbon alpha to the amide carbonyl. This construction is chosen such that the groups on the "phantom" ring are in the preferred para orientation. The "phantom" bonds are drawn dashed in the structure below.  
EMI30.1     




   As detailed previously, the amidine functionality is removed and replaced with the remainder of the urea moiety. The bond of connection in this example is the amide bond. In some embodiments it may be desirable to add functionality at or adjacent to the bond of connection. Thus, in this example, an optional methylene is inserted between the urea inner phenyl ring and the amide carbonyl.



  Thus, the compound having the structure below possesses VLA-4 inhibitory activity without having significant   IIb/IIIa    activity.
EMI30.2     




  Teaching IV:
 In a further embodiment, certain original IIb/IIIa compounds possess a 4,4'-bispiperidyl moiety as a specificity determinant as shown in the structure below (WO 94/14776, herein claimed by reference).  
EMI31.1     




   This example is similar to Teaching   II;    a "phantom" ring is formed between the 3 and 3' carbons of the bispiperidyl system as follows:
EMI31.2     

 As in previous teachings, the unneeded atoms are removed such that the resultant "phantom" ring is para-substituted.  
EMI32.1     




   The amidine function is removed and the urea constructed as in
Teaching I. In this example, the bond of connection is the amide bond. In some embodiments it may be desirable to modify the functionality at the bond of connection. Thus, in this case, the highlighted amide linkage could be reversed. The compound(s) resulting from this conversion possess(es) inhibitory activity toward VLA-4 without significant IIb/IIIa activity.
EMI32.2     




   The steps of Teaching IV may be applied to structures having similar IIb/IIIa specificity determinants exemplified by, but not limited to, 4-piperazinylphenyl, 4-pyridyl-piperazinyl, 4    piperidinylpiperazinyl,    4-piperidinylphenyl, and 4vinylpiperidinyl.



   A similar process to that outlined in Teachings   I-lV    for identifying novel VLA-4 inhibitory compounds can be applied to   IIb/IIIa    inhibitors that contain functional groups in their specificity determinants such as, for example,   amiinophenyl,    bispiperidyl,   piperidyl,    benzylamino, pyridinyl,   aminopyridyl    alkylamino, amidinopiperazinyl, guanidino and the like. Thus, these analyses are similar to those specifically illustrated above.



  Furthermore, application of the above Teachings not only identifies the specificity determinants and integrin scaffolds but, by default, the bond of connection between the two moieties as well.



  Hence, the specificity determinant portion of a IIb/IIIa inhibitor is clearly distinguishable from the integrin scaffold such that
VLA-4 inhibitory compounds will result from the suitable interchange of specificity determinants. VLA-4 inhibitors arising from the analysis herein may be further improved by a lengthening, shortening, reversal or replacement of functionality at or immediately adjacent to the bond of connection between the VLA-4 specificity determinants and the integrin scaffolds. Such connecting functionality includes, but is not limited to   Cl-C3    alkyl, C1-C3 alkenyl, C1-C3 alkynyl, amide, ester, ether, and thioether. However, to one skilled in the art such changes would be deemed obvious and any alterations would be made on the basis of the compound characteristics desired.

   Furthermore, although
Teachings I-IV all provide for the introduction of a omethylphenylureidophenyl moiety to comprise the VLA-4 specificity determinant, it will be understood that any VLA-4 specificity determinant can be interchanged with any other as set forth in detail elsewhere in this application. Thus, the teaching above  enables one skilled in the art to convert virtually any compound possessing   IIb/IIIa    inhibitory activity to a VLA-4 inhibitor.



  Teaching V:
 In another embodiment, any VLA-4 specificity determinant, once identified, can be interchanged with any other such that a new compound possessing VLA-4 inhibitory activity is obtained For example, the compound below is a VLA-4 inhibitor obtained as described above.
EMI34.1     




   The bond of connection is the amide bond. Thus, the VLA-4 specificity determinant is the o-methylphenylureido-phenylacetyl moiety. This can be replaced in its entirety with a different VLA4 specificity determinant such as, for example, the   indolylcarbonylaminophenylacetyl    moiety as depicted below. This compound possesses VLA-4 inhibitory activity.
EMI34.2     
  



  Teachina VI
 In yet another embodiment, the VLA-4 specificity determinant can be replaced and the bond of connection also modified as discussed in Teaching IV above. For example, the omethylphenylureidophenylacetyl moiety of Teaching V can be replaced with the VLA-4 specificity determinant o-hydroxyphenylethynylphenylacetyl as shown below. This alternative VLA-4 specificity determinant is disclosed elsewhere in this application.



  This new compound possesses VLA-4 inhibitory activity.
EMI35.1     




   In the second step, the amide bond of connection can be replaced with, for example, an ether linkage as depicted.
EMI35.2     




  Since such an exchange of functionality can be made at or immediately adjacent to the bond of connection, the oxygen atom of the ether linkage could be located in place of either of the  highlighted carbons instead. The compound(s) resulting from this conversion possess(es) VLA-4 inhibitory activity. Thus, Teachings
V and VI enable one skilled in the art to both predictably exchange
VLA-4 specificity determinants as well as modify functionality at the bond of connection while retaining selective VLA-4 inhibitory activity.  



   Compositions of the Invention
 This invention provides a broad class of novel compounds which are capable of inhibiting VLA-4-mediated cell adhesion by inhibiting the binding of ligands to that receptor. These compounds are represented by formula (I):
 A-B (I) wherein A is a specificity determinant and B is an integrin scaffold. Specifically, A comprises a VLA-4 specificity determinant which does not impart significant IIb/IIIa activity, and B comprises an integrin scaffold, preferably the integrin scaffold from a IIb/IIIa inhibitor.

   More specifically, the present invention encompasses compounds of Formula (I) and pharmaceutically acceptable derivatives thereof, wherein:
 A is a specificity determinant selected from the group consisting of alkyl; aliphatic acyl optionally substituted with
N-alkyl- or N-arylamido; aroyl; heterocycloyl; alkyl- or arylsulfonyl; aralkylcarbonyl optionally substituted with aryl; heterocycloalkylcarbonyl; alkoxycarbonyl; aralkyloxycarbonyl; cycloalkylcarbonyl optionally fused with aryl; heterocycloalkoxycarbonyl; alkylaminocarbonyl; arylamino carbonyl and aralkylaminocarbonyl optionally substituted with   bis (alkylsulfonyl) amino,    alkoxycarbonylamino or alkenyl; alkylsulfonyl; aralkylsulfonyl; arylsulfonyl; cycloalkylsulfonyl optionally fused with aryl; heterocyclylsulfonyl; heterocyclylalkylsulfonyl; aralkoxycarbonyl; aryloxycarbonyl;  cycloalkyloxycarbonyl;

   heterocyclyloxycarbonyl; heterocyclylalkoxycarbonyl; mono- or di-alkylaminocarbonyl optionally substituted with aryl; (alkyl)(aralkyl)aminocarbonyl; mono- or di-aralkylaminocarbonyl; mono- or di-arylaminocarbonyl;   (aryl) (alkyl) aminocarbonyl;    mono- or di-cycloalkylaminocarbonyl; heterocyclylaminocarbonyl; heterocyclylalkylaminocarbonyl;
 (alkyl) (heterocyclyl) aminocarbonyl;
 (alkyl) (heterocyclylalkyl) aminocarbonyl; (aralkyl) (heterocyclyl) aminocarbonyl;
 (aralkyl) (heterocyclylalkyl) aminocarbonyl; alkenoyl optionally substituted with aryl; alkenylsulfonyl optionally substituted with aryl; alkynoyl optionally substituted with aryl; alkynylsulfonyl optionally substituted with aryl; cycloalkenylcarbonyl; cycloalkenylsulfonyl; cycloalkylalkanoyl; cycloalkylsulfonyl; arylaroyl, biarylsulfonyl; alkoxysulfonyl; aralkoxysulfonyl; alkylaminosulfonyl;

   aryloxysulfonyl; arylaminosulfonyl; N-arylurea-substituted alkanoyl; N-arylureasubstituted alkylsulfonyl; cycloalkenyl-substituted carbonyl; cycloalkenyl-substituted sulfonyl; alkenoxycarbonyl optionally substituted with aryl; alkenoxysulfonyl optionally substituted with aryl; alkynoxycarbonyl optionally substituted with aryl; alkynoxysulfonyl optionally substituted with aryl; alkenyl- or alkynyl-aminocarbonyl optionally substituted with aryl; alkenylor alkynyl-aminosulfonyl optionally substituted with aryl; acylamino-substituted alkanoyl; acylamino-substituted alkylsulfonyl; aminocarbonyl-substituted alkanoyl; carbamoylsubstituted alkanoyl; carbamoyl-substituted alkylsulfonyl; heterocyclylalkanoyl; heterocyclylaminosulfonyl; carboxyalkyl
 substituted   aralkoyl;    carboxyalkyl-substituted aralkylsulfonyl;  oxocarbocyclyl-fused aroyl;

   oxocarbocyclyl-fused arylsulfonyl; heterocyclylalkanoyl;   N' , N' -alkyl,    arylhydrazinocarbonyl; aryloxy-substituted alkanoyl and heterocyclylalkylsulfonyl; alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, aryl-fused cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, aryl-substituted alkyl ("aralkyl"), arylsubstituted alkenyl or alkynyl, cycloalkyl-substituted alkyl, cycloalkenyl-substituted cycloalkyl, biaryl, alkoxy, alkenoxy, alkynoxy, aryl-substituted alkoxy ("aralkoxy"), aryl-substituted alkenoxy or alkynoxy, alkylamino, alkenylamino or alkynylamino, aryl-substituted alkylamino, aryl-substituted alkenylamino or alkynylamino, aryloxy, arylamino, N-alkylurea-substituted alkyl,
N-arylurea-substituted alkyl, alkylcarbonylamino-substituted alkyl, aminocarbonyl-substituted alkyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclyl-substituted alkyl, heterocyclyl-substituted amino, carboxyalkyl substituted aralkyl,

   oxocarbocyclyl-fused aryl and heterocyclylalkyl.



   B preferably comprises a scaffold selected from the group consisting of formula IIa, IIb, or IIc,  
NOT FURNISHED UPON FILING  
NOT FURNISHED UPON FILING  
EMI42.1     
 n = 0-5; m = 1-4; q = 1 or 2; r = O or 1;
Y is H2 or 0;
W is selected from the group consisting of CO2H, SO3H, PO4H2, tetrazole,and H;   Z is CO or (CR1R2 R2)n;   
R1 and R2 are independently selected from the group consisting of
H; alkyl; alkenyl; alkynyl; cycloalkyl; cycloalkenyl; aryl; aralkyl; heterocycle; and alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heterocycle, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, or carboxamide;   R7    is selected from the group consisting of H; aryl; substituted aryl; aralkyl; alkyl; alkenyl;

   alkyl optionally substituted with  heterocycle, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, alkoxy, or halogen;
R10 is selected from the group consisting of Rê, NHSO2R11, NH2,
ORê, and NHZR12;
R12 is selected from the group consisting of H; alkyl; cycloalkenyl; aryl; aralkyl; heterocycle; and alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, heterocycle, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, carboxamide, or aralkoxy;   Rl3    is H or   -CH2(CH2)CH2-;      R2    and R7 may be taken together to form   -(CH2)m-;   
Rê and R10 may be taken together to form -(CH2)m-;
R11 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl; alkenyl; alkynyl; cycloalkyl; cycloalkenyl; aryl; aralkyl; heterocycle;

   and alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heterocycle, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, or carboxamide.



   In yet another alternate preferred embodiment, B is a structure of formula IVa, IVb, or IVc
EMI43.1     
  
EMI44.1     
 wherein
A4 is selected from the group consisting of   (CR1R2 )n,      0,    S,   NR1, SO2NR1,    CONR1,   CH2NR11,      NR1SO2,    CH2O,   CH2NCOR11,    and CH2CONR1; n = 0-5; m = 1-4;
W is selected from the group consisting of CO2H, SO3H, PO4H2, tetrazole, and H;
Z is CO, or (CRÚRê)n;
R1 and R2 are independently selected from the group consisting of
H, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocycle; alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heterocycle, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, and carboxamide;

     R4    is selected from the group consisting of H,   OR1,    SR1, NR1R2, alkyl,   NZR1,    NSO2R11, and   CO2Rl;   
R5 and R6 are independently selected from the group consisting of
H, OR1, halogen, alkyl, and NRÚRê; and
R11 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocycle; alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl,  heterocycle, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, and carboxamide.



   In an alternate preferred embodiment, B comprises a structure of formula Va, or Vb.
EMI45.1     




  A6 is selected from the group consisting of NR1, O, S,
CRÚ (NRÚRê), and (CRÚRê) r;
A5 is selected from the group consisting of   S02R11,    COR7,   and (CR1R2 )R7;    n = 0-5; m = 1-4; r =   0    or 1;
W is selected from the group consisting of CO2H, SO3H, PO4H2, tetrazole, and H;
P is CO or   SO2;   
R1 and R2 are independently selected from the group consisting of
H; alkyl; alkenyl; alkynyl; cycloalkyl; cycloalkenyl; aryl; aralkyl; heterocycle; and alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heterocycle, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, or carboxamide  
R7 iS selected from the group consisting of H; aryl; substituted aryl; aralkyl; alkyl; alkenyl;

   alkyl optionally substituted with heterocycle, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxy carbonyl, alkoxy, or halogen;
When R8 is H then R9 is R7, or R8 and R9 are taken together to form a 4-7 member ring optionally substituted with hydroxyl, -OR1   N1R1R21    -SR1,   S02R11,    -SOR11;
R11 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl; alkenyl; alkynyl; cycloalkyl; cycloalkenyl; aryl; aralkyl; heterocycle; and alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heterocycle, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, or carboxamide
 The chemical groups defined as "A" in formula I are examples of the aforementioned "specificity determinant". The chemical groups defined as "B" in formula I are examples of the aforementioned "integrin scaffold".

   While specific examples of
 "integrin scaffolds" from known IIb/IIIa inhibitors are delineated, chemical structural derivatives of these IIb/IIIa inhibitors would be known to one of skill in the art to possess similar IIb/IIIa inhibitory activity. It is also envisioned that "integrin scaffolds" from such IIb/IIIa derivatives or from any compound that can be shown to have IIb/IIIa activity, could be incorporated into VLA-4 inhibitors of the present invention.



   A "pharmaceutically acceptable derivative" denotes any pharmaceutically acceptable salt, ester, salt of such ester,
 amide, or salt of such amide, of a compound of this invention.



   The invention also includes any other compound which, upon
 administration to a patient, is capable of providing (directly  or indirectly) a compound of this invention (e.g. a pro-drug).

 

  The invention also includes metabolites or residues of a compound of this invention characterized by the ability to inhibit, prevent or suppress cell adhesion and cell adhesionmediated pathologies.



   In another preferred embodiment, A is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, aliphatic acyl optionally substituted with N-alkyl- or N-arylamido, aroyl, heterocycloyl, alkyl- and arylsulfonyl, aralkylcarbonyl optionally substituted with aryl, heterocycloalkylcarbonyl, alkoxycarbonyl, aralkyloxycarbonyl, cycloalkylcarbonyl optionally fused with aryl, heterocycloalkoxycarbonyl,   alkylaminocarbonyl,    arylaminocarbonyl and aralkylaminocarbonyl optionally substituted with bis-(alkylsulfonyl)amino, alkoxycarbonylamino or alkenyl.



   More  



   Examples of more preferred compounds include compound described in Table 1.



   The most preferred compounds are those described in
Table 3.



   Furthermore, the preferred compounds have an IC50 of about 1 pM to about 10   uM    as measured by a VLA-4 binding assay. More preferred inhibitors have an IC50 of less than about 100 nM, more preferably about 1 pM to about 100 nM, and most preferably, about 1 pM to about 10 nM.



     Novel IIb/IIIa    inhibitors and Methods of making them
 In other embodiments, applicants have discovered that they can successfully convert novel VLA-4 inhibitors having an integrin scaffold for which no IIb/IIIa precedent exists into novel IIb/IIIa inhibitors. Applicants have thus further demonstrated the portability of IIb/IIIa and VLA-4 scaffolds by creating novel IIb/IIIa inhibitors, replacing the specificity determinant of a novel VLA-4 inhibitor with a IIb/IIIa specificity determinant. Specifically, VLA-4 inhibitors having novel scaffolds, such as the peptoid scaffolds, can be converted to novel IIb/IIIa inhibitors by replacing the VLA-4 specificity determinant with a IIb/IIIa specificity determinant.

   Thus, for example, one has a compound of Formula I, wherein A is a VLA-4 specificity determinant, and B is a VLA-4 scaffold, preferably comprising a peptoid. One then replaces the original A with a specificity determinant having IIb/IIIa activity, thereby creating a novel compound having IIb/IIIa inhibitory activity.



   This concept is demonstrated by compound A, whose structure is shown below:  
EMI49.1     

 Compound A
Compound A, a compound having VLA-4 inhibitory activity, comprises a specificity determinant which does not impart significant IIb/IIIa activity, and an integrin scaffold as illustrated. No examples of this integrin scaffold are reported in IIb/IIIa literature. Replacing the VLA-4 specificity determinant with a IIb/IIIa specificity determinant such as bispiperidinyl, results in a compound such as Compound B, which is
EMI49.2     


<tb> · <SEP> COOH
<tb>  <SEP> d <SEP> e
<tb>  <SEP> Compound <SEP> B
<tb>  a potent IIb/IIIa inhibitor.



   Thus, in one preferred embodiment, compounds represented by
PB-1 and PB-2 are also claimed as novel IIb/IIIa inhibitors derived by combining a novel VLA4 scaffolds with known IIb/IIIa specificity determinants,  
EMI50.1     
 where A is any IIb/IIIa specificity determinant such as those exemplified in table-2.



  A3 is selected from the group consisting of   NR1,    O, S,   and(CR1R2 )r;   
A5 is selected from the group consisting of   S02R11,    COR7, and    (CRlR2) R7i    n = 0-5; m = 1-4; r = 0, 1;
W is selected from the group consisting of   CO2H,    SO3H, PO4H2, tetrazole, and H;
P is selected from the group consisting of CO,   SO2;   
R1 and R2 are independently selected from the group consisting of
H; alkyl; alkenyl; alkynyl; cycloalkyl; cycloalkenyl; aryl; aralkyl; heterocycle; and alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heterocycle, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, or alkoxycarbonyl, carboxamide;
R7 is selected from the group consisting of H; aryl; substituted aryl; aralkyl; alkyl; alkenyl;

   and alkyl optionally substituted with heterocycle, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxy carbonyl, alkoxy, or halogen;  
R15 and R16 are independently H or methyl;
   R11    is selected from the group consisting of alkyl; alkenyl; alkynyl; cycloalkyl; cycloalkenyl; aryl; aralkyl; heterocycle; and alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heterocycle, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, or carboxamide.



   This conversion demonstrates that new IIb/IIIa inhibitors may now be designed based on integrin scaffolds discovered from VLA-4 inhibitors. Thus, VLA-4 inhibitors of the invention are a new source of integrin scaffolds useful for creating novel IIb/IIIa inhibitors.



   For ease of discussion, applicants have exemplified the pharmaceutical preparations and methods of treatment herein as they refer to the VLA-4 inhibitors of the invention. However, applicants claimed invention is intended to encompass the same preparations and methods of treatment disclosed herein comprising novel IIb/IIIa inhibitors instead of, or in addition to, the claimed VLA-4 inhibitors.  



     Structure-Activity 9 TABLE 1 216 Compounds   
EMI52.1     

 ·:it:iMy· <SEP> µ <SEP> 2 <SEP> m
<tb>  <SEP> Name: <SEP> ' <SEP> t)\ <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> SXsl <SEP> Act <SEP> Name: <SEP> BX62 <SEP> ACt:
<tb>  <SEP> ¸)
<tb>  <SEP> ·.
<tb>



   <SEP> ·
<tb> 8
<tb> Name: <SEP> BXOe <SEP> ¯
<tb> X <SEP> s <SEP> X <SEP> f <SEP> . <SEP> X <SEP> .¯ <SEP> X
<tb>  <SEP> X <SEP> X <SEP> 0
<tb> n <SEP> / <SEP> fef <SEP> ) <SEP>  &  <SEP> t
<tb>     Structure-Activity 9 TABLE 1 216 Compounds   
EMI53.1     


<tb>  <SEP> ¸. <SEP> 'Oy <SEP> .
<tb>



   <SEP> ¸ <SEP> 'N <SEP> s <SEP> \
<tb>  <SEP> "- <SEP> 4·
<tb> Name: <SEP> " <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> BXl3 <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> BXl4 <SEP> Act:
<tb>  <SEP> . <SEP> .tS <SEP> X <SEP> ¯ <SEP> . <SEP> X <SEP> . <SEP> N
<tb>  <SEP> . <SEP> | <SEP> . <SEP> a <SEP> | <SEP> ! <SEP> M
<tb>  <SEP> 'Cii
<tb> Name: <SEP> .XY <SEP> U <SEP> Act: <SEP> U
<tb>  <SEP> 1¯. <SEP> New,,; <SEP> 
<tb>  <SEP> ss <SEP> D <SEP> i¯ <SEP> X <SEP> X <SEP> x
<tb> Name <SEP> BXiS <SEP> t, <SEP> | <SEP> 7,/ <SEP> |
<tb>  <SEP> tO$- <SEP> X <SEP> /X- <SEP>  <  <SEP> W- <SEP>  < o
<tb>  <SEP> a <SEP> g <SEP> Xm <SEP>  <  <SEP> m <SEP> ( <SEP> )) <SEP> m
<tb>  <SEP> ( <SEP> ) <SEP> &verbar; <SEP> za <SEP> E <SEP> t <SEP> E
<tb>     Structure-Activity 9 TABLE 1 216 Compounds   
EMI54.1     


 <SEP> ·
<tb> g <SEP> 4 <SEP> ,\ <SEP>  > 
<tb> 0
<tb> N <SEP> 0
<tb>  <SEP> Name:

   <SEP> Ax39 <SEP> Ac?: <SEP> Name: <SEP> AX4O <SEP> Act. <SEP> n <SEP> Name: <SEP> Ax41 <SEP> Act:
<tb>  <SEP> zl <SEP> p
<tb>  <SEP> · <SEP> Qt:iO·
<tb> Name: <SEP> .X >  <SEP> Name: <SEP> x <SEP>  < )
<tb>  <SEP> -I <SEP> ·:%M)¸&num;.. <SEP> ·' <SEP> ·
<tb>  <SEP> L <SEP> 2 <SEP> - < 
<tb>  <SEP> S <SEP> 3 <SEP> 53 <SEP> ?
<tb>     Structure-Activity TABLE 1 216 Compounds   
EMI55.1     

 )
<tb>  <SEP> cu <SEP> ru <SEP> ·I..·M,,¸N¸Th. <SEP> s <SEP> N <SEP> N
<tb>  <SEP> Name: <SEP> BX23 <SEP> Act: <SEP> N <SEP> Act: <SEP> - <SEP> :,Na
<tb> ·, <SEP> m
<tb>  <SEP> g <SEP> . <SEP> .¸ <SEP> ,
<tb>  <SEP> Name: <SEP> BX2T <SEP> ArX
<tb> /
<tb>  <SEP> N
<tb>  <SEP> NN. <SEP> N <SEP> ·
<tb>  <SEP> N <SEP> · <SEP> N
<tb>  <SEP> Name <SEP> BX3O <SEP> Act: <SEP> 4 <SEP> Name: <SEP> BX3l <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> BX2 <SEP> iAct:
<tb> z <SEP> el, <SEP> &verbar;

   <SEP> 01. <SEP> i¯'
<tb> 3 <SEP> /( <SEP> * <SEP> mD <SEP> 0
<tb> &verbar; <SEP> ! <SEP> /"; <SEP> &verbar; <SEP> /; <SEP> ;
<tb>     Structure-Activity 9 TABLE 1 216 Compounds   
EMI56.1     

 ·
<tb>  <SEP> ·
<tb>  <SEP> "
<tb>  <SEP> . <SEP> A <SEP> N
<tb>  <SEP> I <SEP> I
<tb>  <SEP> Name: <SEP> BX334 <SEP> x <SEP> 0 <SEP> 3 <SEP> 0
<tb>  <SEP> &commat; <SEP> 4 <SEP> ! <SEP> ?
<tb>  <SEP> · <SEP> - <SEP> /NTh
<tb>  <SEP> | <SEP> W <SEP> I <SEP>  < 
<tb>  <SEP> Name: <SEP> .= <SEP> m <SEP>  <  <SEP> Ex <SEP>  ,)
<tb>  <SEP> a <SEP> C <SEP> a <SEP> C
<tb>  <SEP> .. <SEP> --N;
<tb>  <SEP> .4. <SEP> ·.
<tb>



  Name: <SEP> BX39 <SEP> Act: <SEP> .L <SEP> ss <SEP> | <SEP> .X- > 
<tb>  <SEP> &verbar; <SEP> ,9- <SEP> g <SEP> {? <SEP> &verbar;
<tb>  <SEP> r <SEP> tS <SEP>  <  <SEP> gx <SEP> ?f-))
<tb>  <SEP> 4-X <SEP> ar)e <SEP> 40?
<tb>  <SEP>  >  <SEP> J <SEP> ( <SEP> R <SEP> (Up <SEP> R <SEP> /R/
<tb>  <SEP> &verbar; <SEP> !- <SEP> &verbar; <SEP> f <SEP> I <SEP> &verbar; <SEP> !
<tb>     Structure-Activity 9 TABLE 1 216 Compounds @   
EMI57.1     


 <SEP> MN <SEP> otoi
<tb>  <SEP> a
<tb> z <SEP> z <SEP>   ZI
<tb> Mc
<tb> Name: <SEP> / <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> SX43 <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> BX44 <SEP> Act:
<tb>  <SEP> 4 <SEP> I
<tb>  <SEP> ·.
<tb>



   <SEP> Name: <SEP> BX4S <SEP> Act: <SEP> ' <SEP> Name: <SEP> BX46 <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> BX47 <SEP> Act:
<tb>  <SEP> ¸
 <SEP> x <SEP> .iX <SEP> x <SEP> Q\ &  <SEP> ¯ <SEP> &num;.·
<tb>  <SEP> ymyjA
<tb>  <SEP> Name: <SEP> BX4B <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> BX49 <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> BX5O <SEP> 1Act:
<tb> x <SEP> 6) ) <SEP> 3 <SEP> J <SEP> 3 <SEP> 4'l)
<tb> oo <SEP> \Ci, <SEP> .Rp <SEP> 90; <SEP>  > 
<tb> &verbar; <SEP> H <SEP> &verbar; <SEP> !- <SEP> i <SEP> t!-     Structure-Activity 9 TABLE 9 216 Compounds   
EMI58.1     


<tb> A
<tb>  <SEP> 0
<tb>  <SEP> Name: <SEP> SX5l <SEP> Act: <SEP> ''r" <SEP> Name: <SEP> 9X52 <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> 5X53 <SEP> Act:
<tb>  <SEP> MN.
<tb>



   <SEP> 0
<tb>  <SEP> AM <SEP> ·
<tb>  <SEP> Name: <SEP> BXS4 <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> BX55 <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> BXS6 <SEP> Act:
<tb> It <SEP> ,¯, <SEP> &verbar; <SEP> o.9 <SEP> X <SEP> ve
<tb>  <SEP> 4 <SEP> ss <SEP> &num;.· <SEP> 4
<tb> Name: <SEP> BX5T <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> BXOS <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> BXS9 <SEP> Act:
<tb>  <SEP> X, <SEP> lz <SEP> X, <SEP> lz <SEP> -41
<tb>  <SEP> / <SEP> , <SEP> E <SEP> E <SEP> oSO
<tb>     Structure-Activity 9 TABLE 1 216 Compounds   
EMI59.1     


<tb>  <SEP> p <SEP> 1
<tb>  <SEP> Mt <SEP> .
<tb>



   <SEP> ·
<tb> Name: <SEP> 6X72 <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> UXI <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> Ux2 <SEP> Act:
<tb>  <SEP> Name: <SEP> Axi <SEP> Act: <SEP> I <SEP> Act:
<tb>     Structure-Activity 9 TABLE 1 216 Compounds   
EMI60.1     


 <SEP> a <SEP> A- <SEP> i
<tb>  <SEP> ¸) <SEP> N
<tb>  <SEP> Name: <SEP> AX3 <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> AX4 <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> Ax5 <SEP> Act:
<tb>  <SEP> y <SEP> MN. <SEP> ·'; <SEP> {%.\. <SEP> MM.
<tb>



   <SEP> $ <SEP> y <SEP> ¸
<tb>  <SEP> Name: <SEP> E <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> ; <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> W <SEP> Act:
<tb> ·
<tb>  <SEP> ·" <SEP> 'NN
<tb> W <SEP> R
<tb>  <SEP> Name: <SEP> +4 <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> Ax1O <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> Axil <SEP> Act:
<tb> t <SEP> W
<tb>     Structure-Activity 9 TABLE 1 216 Compounds   
EMI61.1     


 <SEP>  < Ce <SEP> 
<tb>  <SEP> ¸ <SEP> N; <SEP> ¸offoHy <SEP> · <SEP> ·.
<tb>



   <SEP> R <SEP> I <SEP> ·
<tb> N
<tb>  <SEP> Name: <SEP> AX12 <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> Ax13 <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> AXl4 <SEP> Act:
<tb>  <SEP> t <SEP> . <SEP> .
<tb>



   <SEP> 2, <SEP>  > t <SEP> ; <SEP> f <SEP> i <SEP> \ <SEP> gt
<tb>  <SEP> \ <SEP> "" <SEP> b <SEP> &num;
<tb>  <SEP> Name: <SEP> ¯ <SEP> ¯¯ <SEP> x <SEP> Act: <SEP> ¯x
<tb>  <SEP> N'
<tb>  <SEP> 1,
<tb>  <SEP> )·.I. <SEP> N <SEP> NN <SEP> N
<tb>  <SEP> ·. <SEP> ye
<tb>  <SEP> 2S <SEP> h
<tb> t <SEP> E <SEP> a
<tb>  <SEP> x <SEP>  > f <SEP> 'x <SEP> . <SEP> Wi <SEP>  >  <SEP> - <SEP> 4 <SEP> V
<tb>     Structure-Activity 9 TABLE 1 216 Compounds   
EMI62.1     

 z <SEP> - <SEP> . <SEP> N
<tb> * <SEP> N,- <SEP> ,M., <SEP> ,t;·YO"' <SEP> A <SEP> .% <SEP> N
<tb> . <SEP> · <SEP> &num; <SEP> N
<tb> Name: <SEP> AX2l <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP>   <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> Ax23 <SEP> 'Act:
<tb>  <SEP> (" <SEP> R
<tb>  <SEP> R <SEP> i <SEP> * <SEP> j <SEP> SJy
<tb>  <SEP> o,
<tb> Name: <SEP> AX24 <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> AX25 <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name:

   <SEP> Ax26 <SEP> Act
<tb> m <SEP> N.·v <SEP> .e:I. <SEP> .. <SEP> . <SEP> N- <SEP> N <SEP> NN <SEP> N
<tb> ye <SEP> NNNN-./N.¸ <SEP> N
<tb>  <SEP> - <SEP> - <SEP> N <SEP> 0 <SEP> Yf <SEP> N
<tb> Name: <SEP> AX27 <SEP> 1 <SEP> , <SEP> . <SEP>  < ' < 
<tb> fflz <SEP>  > : < ,, <SEP> 1 <SEP> b <SEP> lZI <SEP> Cj
<tb>  <SEP> lie <SEP> J)d' <SEP> "/ <SEP> &commat;,
<tb>     Structure-Activity 9 TABLE 1 216 Compounds   
EMI63.1     

 . <SEP> K
<tb>  <SEP> , <SEP> ir"
<tb>  <SEP> N. <SEP> C, <SEP> '
<tb>  <SEP> F'
<tb> N <SEP> · <SEP> N
<tb> Name: <SEP> Ax3O <SEP> Act: <SEP> " < r <SEP> Name: <SEP> Ax31 <SEP> Act: <SEP> 1' <SEP> 'S <SEP> Name: <SEP> Ax32 <SEP> Act:
<tb>  <SEP> ·. <SEP> A
<tb>  <SEP> I <SEP> oo· <SEP> ' <SEP> ·
<tb>  <SEP> t4'
<tb>  <SEP> "''N <SEP> 0
<tb>  <SEP> Name: <SEP> AX33 <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> ox <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name:

   <SEP> x <SEP> 'Act:
<tb>  <SEP> 0 <SEP> 0 <SEP> N
<tb>  <SEP> s-X <SEP> a-k <SEP> Xt
<tb>  <SEP> A; <SEP> ·:,:,M0I·)·0ffi0 <SEP> ""N
<tb>  <SEP> Name: <SEP> AX36 <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> Ax37 <SEP> Act: <SEP>  > X
<tb>  <SEP> °, <SEP> t <SEP> R <SEP> t <SEP> q <SEP>  >  <SEP> 9
<tb> EZ <SEP> . <SEP> Kz <SEP> Z'
<tb> i <SEP> n <SEP> (t <SEP> n <SEP> i >  <SEP> /
<tb> &verbar; <SEP> &verbar; <SEP> ss <SEP> i <SEP> * <SEP> /"z <SEP> D
<tb>     Structure-Activity 9 TABLE 1 216 Compounds   
EMI64.1     


 <SEP> 'N <SEP> &num;v""' <SEP> .t., <SEP> N <SEP> N <SEP> Th <SEP> N
<tb>  <SEP> N,, <SEP> . <SEP> " <SEP> r <SEP> N
<tb> Name: <SEP> CX4 <SEP> Act <SEP> Name: <SEP> ? <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> .! <SEP> Act'
<tb>  <SEP> c
<tb>  <SEP> a <SEP> .R <SEP> .S <SEP> .ss >  <SEP> , <SEP> t
<tb> I <SEP> I
<tb>  <SEP> rz
<tb>  <SEP> Name:

   <SEP>  <  Si <SEP> X <SEP> Name: <SEP> ..j <SEP> Ad: <SEP> Name: <SEP> CX9 <SEP> lAct:
<tb>  <SEP> o <SEP> o <SEP> C
<tb>  <SEP> X <SEP> A <SEP> ,y <SEP> ·
<tb>  <SEP> , >  <SEP> C, > 4- <SEP> ¯ <SEP> '
<tb>  <SEP> Name: <SEP> Cell <SEP> S-t <SEP> , <SEP> , <SEP> X
<tb> K <SEP> w <SEP> z
<tb>  x <SEP> - <SEP> o <SEP> ,9i <SEP> o <SEP> f <SEP>  > 
<tb>  <SEP> &verbar; <SEP> ,- <SEP> &verbar; <SEP> C;+- <SEP> 902
<tb>  <SEP> .( <SEP> I <SEP> ( < e <SEP> I <SEP> sA
<tb>     Structure-Activity 9 TABLE 1 216 Compounds   
EMI65.1     


 <SEP> z <SEP> N.AN <SEP> z
<tb> 3 <SEP> ° <SEP> ) <SEP> X <SEP> X <SEP> / <SEP> \
<tb>  <SEP> Name: <SEP> CXl3 <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> SX3 <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name:

   <SEP> SX4 <SEP> 'Ac':
<tb>  <SEP> N <SEP> N
<tb>  <SEP> ,FI' <SEP> N
<tb>  <SEP> ¸ <SEP> ( <SEP> DyQIN'. <SEP> r <SEP> I,z <SEP> t <SEP> N
<tb>  <SEP> N
<tb>  <SEP> Name: <SEP> SX5 <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> SXS <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> SX7 <SEP> lAct:
<tb> k¸ <SEP> N
<tb>  <SEP> N. <SEP> ,NN <SEP> . <SEP> ¯¯¯
<tb>  <SEP> '· <SEP> N <SEP> N. <SEP> w <SEP> 
<tb>  <SEP> g <SEP> .=
<tb>  <SEP> Name: <SEP> , <SEP> 8 <SEP> 
<tb>  >  <SEP> ,° > 0,P' <SEP> ( <SEP> ss <SEP> &verbar; <SEP> ,&verbar;'
<tb>     Structure-Activity 9 TABLE 1 216 Compounds   
EMI66.1     


<tb>  <SEP> z <SEP> its <SEP> "-N'," <SEP> 1 <SEP> :' <SEP> . <SEP> N, <SEP> N, <SEP> N
<tb>  <SEP> Name: <SEP> SXl2 <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> SXl3 <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> SXl4 <SEP> Act:
<tb>  <SEP> A.
<tb>



   <SEP> U, <SEP> Am <SEP> · <SEP> ;,N <SEP> 1'M%:'o <SEP> ·..M.'&num;· <SEP> :N
<tb>  <SEP> N"''. <SEP> ."" <SEP> N <SEP> I <SEP> A.
<tb>



  Name: <SEP> SXl5 <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> SXl6 <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> SXl7 <SEP> Act:
<tb>  <SEP> 'tt" <SEP> .. <SEP> ¯ <SEP> N
<tb>  <SEP> X,r <SEP> ;' <SEP> t
<tb> R <SEP> \ <SEP> / <SEP> B <SEP> .s <SEP> 3 <SEP> 902
<tb> Fb <SEP> EZ <SEP> BZ
<tb>     Structure-Activity 9 TABLE 1 216 Compounds   
EMI67.1     


F) <SEP> Isl <SEP> ¯
<tb> 3 <SEP> 3 <SEP> 7 <SEP> "' <SEP> ' <SEP> .,·. <SEP> N <SEP> N <SEP> 
<tb> I <SEP> F
<tb>  <SEP> Name: <SEP> (( <SEP> Act: <SEP> N <SEP> Name: <SEP> SX23 <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> SX24 <SEP> Act:
<tb>  <SEP> :I <SEP> · <SEP> ,; <SEP> '. <SEP> .
<tb>



   <SEP> "N"'.
<tb>



  "N <SEP> . <SEP> 0' <SEP> t <SEP> &num;Cftm <SEP> ",'NN
<tb>  <SEP> 0' <SEP> \w,.
<tb>



   <SEP> Name. <SEP> SX25 <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> Sx26 <SEP> Act: <SEP> 9 <SEP> Name: <SEP> SX2T <SEP> 1ACt:
<tb>  <SEP> W <SEP> g <SEP> r3 <SEP> 9 <SEP> N <SEP>  
<tb>  <SEP> I <SEP> I
<tb>  <SEP> N <SEP> 
<tb>  <SEP> .T' <SEP> -g
<tb>  <SEP> 3Z <SEP> F <SEP> ' <SEP> 3Z <SEP> ta <SEP> 3 <SEP> - 0)
<tb>     Structure-Activity 9 TABLE 1 216 Compounds   
EMI68.1     

 - <SEP> W'·.¸ <SEP> f <SEP> ¸ <SEP> w¸DM
<tb>  <SEP> A <SEP> i( <SEP> ,i <SEP> ¸·..&num;. & 
<tb> Name: <SEP> SX3l <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> SX32 <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> SX33 <SEP> Act:
<tb> u, <SEP> ·:,:,!M· <SEP> i' <SEP> ::MTh <SEP> ·- <SEP> u,
<tb> Name: <SEP> 3 <SEP>  < 
<tb>  <SEP> 1 <SEP> .
<tb>



   <SEP> :10 <SEP> ''h <SEP> ¸' <SEP> ;?'· <SEP> N <SEP> - <SEP> 
<tb>  <SEP> ye-I <SEP> v,
<tb>  <SEP> Name: <SEP> SX3S <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> SX39 <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> SX4O <SEP> lAct:
<tb>     Structure-Activity 9 TABLE 1 216 Compounds   
EMI69.1     

 f
<tb>  <SEP> C <SEP> ¸·)F¸.) <SEP> Yi.¸:6? <SEP> y <SEP> w <SEP> yY <SEP> ¸ <SEP> 
<tb>  <SEP> Name: <SEP> SX4l <SEP> Act: <SEP> ' <SEP> Name: <SEP> 6X42 <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> SX43 <SEP> Act:
<tb> U) <SEP> 4 <SEP> V) <SEP> X <SEP> ""'.m&num; <SEP> .'N&num;\
<tb> p".1 <SEP> '0 <SEP> .%· <SEP> ft.
<tb>



   <SEP> Name: <SEP> SX44 <SEP> Act: <SEP> '0 <SEP> Name: <SEP> SX46 <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> 6X46 <SEP> Act:
<tb> ,, <SEP> ¸. <SEP> X <SEP> F <SEP> X <SEP> X <SEP> x <SEP> I-x <SEP>  .
<tb>



   <SEP> Name: <SEP> x-wict:ame: <SEP> W <SEP> C <SEP> r
<tb> U <SEP> ' <SEP> U
<tb>     Structure-Activity 9 TABLE 1 216 Compounds   
EMI70.1     


<tb>  <SEP> N <SEP> ( <SEP> \ <SEP> X <SEP> . <SEP> X <SEP> ç <SEP> /
<tb> 19 <SEP> z <SEP> .m! <SEP> -·
<tb>  <SEP> Name: <SEP> SXSO <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> SX5l <SEP> -9 <SEP> ,z,,
<tb>  <SEP> ""·
<tb>  <SEP> N
<tb>  <SEP> A <SEP> &num;
<tb>  <SEP> Name: <SEP> 5X53 <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> SX54 <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> SX55 <SEP> Act:
<tb>  <SEP> 3 <SEP> ¯ <SEP> ss <SEP> 9o4
<tb>  <SEP> k <SEP> 'Th <SEP> - <SEP> . <SEP> .
<tb>



   <SEP> ·
<tb>  <SEP>  >  <SEP> r
<tb>  <SEP> Name: <SEP> SXSS <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> i <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> MX2 <SEP> Act:
<tb>  <SEP> ZZ <SEP> 1bE <SEP> . <SEP> Ew
<tb>  <SEP> N <SEP> / <SEP> ( <SEP> ; <SEP> 3 <SEP> 4 <SEP> , <SEP> fi
<tb>  <SEP> i <SEP> I')l <SEP> / <SEP> Fs
<tb>     Structure-Activity 9 TABLE 1 216 Compounds   
EMI71.1     

 z <SEP> .N"'·-- <SEP> lzl
<tb>  <SEP> ·. <SEP> ffi. <SEP> . <SEP> - <SEP> ,'
<tb>  <SEP> Name. <SEP> ss <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> ss <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name. <SEP> Q <SEP> Act:
<tb>  <SEP> 
<tb>  <SEP> 6 <SEP> &num;K·l\F <SEP> :'::.-&num; <SEP> -4 <SEP> tLo <SEP> |
<tb> 0 <SEP> 000.' <SEP> F. <SEP> P
<tb> I¯ <SEP> : <SEP> ;-" <SEP> ¸.
<tb>



   <SEP> Name: <SEP> XI <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> RX2 <SEP> Act: <SEP> - <SEP> Name: <SEP> RX3 <SEP> Act:
<tb> c <SEP> - <SEP> .U.&num;·. <SEP> X
<tb>  <SEP> tll <SEP> AM <SEP> ·\ <SEP> M <SEP> N
<tb>  <SEP>  < od <SEP> | <SEP> 4
<tb>  <SEP> Name: <SEP> i <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> Rx5 <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> RX6 <SEP> Act:
<tb>  <SEP> 3C <SEP> / <SEP> x <SEP> ) <SEP> 3 <SEP> /
<tb>  <SEP> S <SEP> ( <SEP> &verbar;
<tb>     Structure-Activity 9 TABLE 1 216 Compounds   
EMI72.1     


<tb>  <SEP> Name: <SEP> RX7 <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> RXS <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> RX9 <SEP> Act:
<tb> 3 <SEP> N <SEP> · <SEP> N
<tb>  <SEP> C
<tb> 2 <SEP> '0. <SEP> ·, <SEP> ·
<tb> I <SEP> ' <SEP> ' <SEP> ¸
<tb>  <SEP> ·
<tb> Name:

   <SEP> i <SEP> Z
<tb> a <SEP> .1 <SEP> '·' <SEP> · <SEP> - <SEP> ·
<tb>  <SEP> ·'
<tb>  <SEP> - <SEP> i/,),/
<tb>     Structure-Activity 9 TABLE 1 216 Compounds   
EMI73.1     

 3 <SEP> 3 <SEP> / <SEP> X <SEP> 3
<tb> Name: <SEP> RXl6 <SEP> D <SEP> X
<tb>  <SEP> S <SEP> '· <SEP> N <SEP> 'N
<tb>  <SEP> Th <SEP> 'Th-K <SEP> 'F
<tb>  <SEP> ·
<tb>  <SEP> 1 <SEP> " <SEP> ;
<tb> | <SEP> Act: <SEP> j <SEP> Name: <SEP> ° <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> RX2l <SEP> 1Act:
<tb>  <SEP> X <SEP>  >  <SEP>  > -X <SEP> X
<tb>  <SEP> II <SEP> I <SEP> %"' <SEP> N <SEP> . <SEP> N <SEP> -N <SEP> N
<tb>  <SEP> Name: <SEP> . <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> 'i/),/
<tb>     Structure-Activity 9 TABLE 1 216 Compounds   
EMI74.1     


Z <SEP> .¸'· <SEP> · <SEP> Isi
<tb>  <SEP> F <SEP> t <SEP> Q"',."'N..&num;, <SEP> ·
<tb>  <SEP> K
<tb> Name:

   <SEP> | <SEP> ) <SEP> X <SEP> \ <SEP> N <SEP> 0 <SEP> } <SEP> e
<tb>  <SEP> ""· <SEP> ,wz <SEP> ,. <SEP> N <SEP> · <SEP> N
<tb> I <SEP> I
<tb> X <SEP> . <SEP> g <SEP> .j <SEP> ·-' <SEP> N <SEP> ·
<tb>  <SEP> F <SEP> 
<tb>  <SEP> N
<tb>  <SEP> N
<tb>  <SEP> Th.
<tb>



  Name: <SEP> MX3 <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> RX3C <SEP> D <SEP>  < .
<tb>



  ¯ <SEP> 3r, <SEP> z <SEP> j <SEP> i <SEP> -0
<tb>  <SEP> i <SEP> x <SEP> i <SEP> 33 <SEP> g)/
<tb>  <SEP> &num; <SEP> S <SEP> ! <SEP> / <SEP> i
<tb>     Structure-Activity 9 TABLE 1 216 Compounds   
EMI75.1     

 ·
<tb>  <SEP> 3 <SEP> .&num;&num;- <SEP> Th. <SEP> .-&num;.
<tb>



   <SEP> ·.
<tb>



  Name: <SEP> SXi <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> BX3 <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> x <SEP> Act:
<tb>  <SEP> 4 <SEP> '
<tb>  <SEP> F <SEP> N)' <SEP> //' <SEP> ¸ <SEP> 
<tb>  <SEP> N
<tb>  <SEP> s <SEP> F
<tb> || <SEP> BXO <SEP> | <SEP> BXT <SEP> Act:
<tb> m
<tb> 'N, <SEP> .
<tb>



   <SEP> F <SEP> F
<tb>  <SEP> 'Mi <SEP> n <SEP> \ <SEP> 
<tb> i <SEP> '  <SEP> ' <SEP> j <SEP> '\ <SEP> J <SEP> %
<tb>   
 Compounds of this invention may be synthesized using any conventional technique. Preferably, these compounds are chemically synthesized from readily available starting materials, such as a-amino acids and their functional equivalents. Modular and convergent methods for the synthesis of these compounds are also preferred. In a convergent approach, for example, large sections of the final product are brought together in the last stages of the synthesis, rather than by incremental addition of small pieces to a growing molecular chain.



   The compounds of this invention may also be modified by appending appropriate functionalities to enhance selective biological properties. Such modifications are known in the art and include those which increase biological penetration into a given biological system (e.g., blood, lymphatic system, central nervous system), increase oral availability, increase solubility to allow administration by injection, alter metabolism and alter rate of excretion. Examples of these modifications include, but are not limited to, esterification with polyethylene glycols, derivatization with pivolates or fatty acid substituents, conversion to carbamates, hydroxylation of aromatic rings, and heteroatom-substitution in aromatic rings.



   As used throughout this application, the term "patient" refers to mammals, including humans. And the term   "cell"    refers to mammalian cells, including human cells.



   Once synthesized, the activities and VLA-4 or IIb/IIIa specificities of the compounds according to this invention may be determined and/or confirmed using in vitro and in   vivo    assays.  



   For example, the cell adhesion inhibitory activity of these compounds may be measured by determining the concentration of inhibitor required to block the binding of VLA-4-expressing cells to fibronectin- or CS1-coated plates. In this assay microtiter wells are coated with either fibronectin (containing the CS-1 sequence) or CS-1. If CS-1 is used, it must be conjugated to a carrier protein, such as bovine serum albumin, in order to bind to the wells. Once the wells are coated, varying concentrations of the test compound are then added together with appropriately labeled, VLA-4-expressing cells.



  Alternatively, the test compound may be added first and allowed to incubate with the coated wells prior to the addition of the cells. The cells are allowed to incubate in the wells for at least 30 minutes. Following incubation, the wells are emptied and washed. Inhibition of binding is measured by quantitating the fluorescence or radioactivity bound to the plate for each of the various concentrations of test compound, as well as for controls containing no test compound.



   VLA-4-expressing cells that may be utilized in this assay include Ramos cells, Jurkat cells, A375 melanoma cells, as well as human peripheral blood lymphocytes (PBLs). These cells are commercially available and may be fluorescently or radioactively labeled if desired.



   A direct binding assay may also be employed to quantitate the inhibitory activity of the compounds of this invention. ("DBA") In direct binding assays, for example, a
VCAM-IgG fusion protein containing the first two immunoglobulin domains of VCAM   (D1D2)    attached above the hinge region of an
IgG1 molecule ("VCAM 2D-IgG"), is conjugated to a marker enzyme,  such as alkaline phosphatase ("AP"). The synthesis of this
VCAM-IgG fusion is described in PCT publication WO 90/13300, the disclosure of which is herein incorporated by reference. The conjugation of that fusion to a marker enzyme can be achieved by cross-linking methods well-known in the art.



   The VCAM-IgG enzyme conjugate is then placed in the wells of a multi-well filtration plate, such as that contained in the Millipore Multiscreen Assay System (Millipore Corp.,
Bedford, MA). Varying concentrations of the test inhibitory compound are then added to the wells followed by addition of
VLA-4-expressing cells. The cells, compound and VCAM-IgG enzyme conjugate are mixed together and allowed to incubate at room temperature.



   Following incubation, the wells are vacuum drained, leaving behind the cells and any bound VCAM. Quantitation of bound VCAM is determined by adding an appropriate colorimetric substrate for the enzyme conjugated to VCAM-IgG and determining the amount of reaction product. Decreased reaction product indicates increased binding inhibitory activity. The protocol is described more specifically below:
A. Preparation of the plate for the assay 1.

   Block a 96 well Millipore Multiscreen Assay System filtration   platel    with 200   :1/well    of blocking buffer
 1 Millipore Multiscreen Assay System (Millipore
Corporation, Bedford,MA)
 96 Well Filtration Plate (catalog &num;MAHV N45 50)
 Vacuum Source (catalog   &num;XX55    000 00)
 Vacuum Manifold (catalog   *MAVM    096 01)  
   (lx    Phosphate Buffered Saline, 0.1%Tween 20, 1%BSA) for at least 1 hour at room temperature.



  2. Drain the plate with the vacuum manifold, and wash with 200   Hl/well    of assay buffer (Tris Buffered Saline,   0.1W    BSA, 2mM glucose, 10mM HEPES, pH 7.5) draining the plate in between.



  Repeat twice. Then blot the plate bottom on paper to remove excess buffer.



  B. Addition of assay reagents to the plate 3. Prepare a 4   pg/ml    VCAMIg-AP solution (Alkaline phosphatase coupled to VCAMIg) in assay buffer and filter with a 0.2 : low protein binding syringe filter (Gelman Sciences &num;4454). From this stock, prepare a 0.4   pg/ml    working solution of VCAMIg-AP in assay buffer. Add 25:1 of 0.4   Fg/ml    VCAMIg-AP to every well.



  5. Prepare dilutions of compounds to be tested in assay buffer.



  Concentrations should be 4x the desired final concentration and run in triplicate. Add 25  l of the compound dilutions to designated wells.



  6. Add 25   pl    of assay buffer   (in    place of test compound) to the total binding (TB) wells and 75   pl    of assay buffer to the Non
Specific Binding (NSB) wells which additionally do not receive cells.



   The Millipore Multiscreen Assay System Operating and
Maintenance Manual  7. Jurkat cells are centrifuged to remove cell culture media and washed once in assay buffer. Resuspend the washed Jurkat cells to a concentration of 8 x 106/ml in assay buffer containing 2 mM MnCl2. Pipeting the mixture up and down to ensure a uniform cell suspension. Add 50:1 of cell suspension to each well except the NSB wells.



  8. Gently tap the sides of the plate to mix well contents.



  Incubate the plate for 60 minutes at room temperature (RT).



  C. Assay color development 9. Place the plate on the vacuum manifold to drain the well contents. Wash twice with 100   pl/well    of wash buffer (assay buffer containing lmM MnCl2). Drain the plate and blot on paper towels.

 

  10. Add 10 mg/ml of 4-Nitro phenyl phosphate to Substrate buffer (0.lM glycine, lmM ZnCl2,   lmM    MgCl21 pH 10.5 ). Add 100   pl/well    and incubate for exactly 30 minutes at RT.



  11. To stop the reaction, add 100   pl/well    of 3N NaOH.



  12. Read the 96-well plate in a Molecular Devices ELISA platereader at 405 nm. Analyze data with SoftMax software.



   In order to assess the VLA-4 inhibitory specificity of the compounds of this invention, assays for other major groups of integrins, i.e.,   ss2    and   ss3,    as well as other 81 integrins, such as VLA-5, VLA-6 and    may be similar to the adhesion inhibition and direct binding assays described above, substituting the appropriate integrinexpressing cell and corresponding ligand. For example, polymorphonuclear cells (PMNs) express   ss2    integrins on their surface and bind to ICAM.   133    integrins are involved in platelet aggregation and inhibition may be measured in a standard platelet aggregation assay.

   VLA-5 binds specifically to Arg
Gly-Asp sequences, while VLA-6 binds to laminin.   a4ss7    is a recently discovered homolog of VLA-4, which also binds fibronectin and VCAM. Specificity with respect to   a4137    is determined in a binding assay that utilizes the above-described
VCAM-IgG-enzyme marker conjugate and a cell line that expresses   a4ss7,    but not VLA-4, such as RPMI-8866 or JY cells.



   Once VLA-4 inhibitors are identified, they may be further characterized in in vivo assays. One such assay tests the inhibition of contact hypersensitivity in an animal, such as described by P.L. Chisholm et al., "Monoclonal Antibodies to the
Integrin a-4 Subunit Inhibit the Murine Contact Hypersensitivity
Response", Eur. J. Immunol., 23, pp. 682-688 (1993) and in "Current Protocols in Immunology", J. E. Coligan, et al., Eds.,
John Wiley  &  Sons, New York, 1, pp. 4.2.1-4.2.5 (1991), the disclosures of which are herein incorporated by reference. In these assays, the skin of the animal is sensitized by exposure to an irritant, such as dinitrofluorobenzene, followed by light physical irritation, such as scratching the skin lightly with a sharp edge. Following a recovery period, the animals are resensitized following the same procedure.

   Several days after sensitization, one ear of the animal is exposed to the chemical irritant, while the other ear is treated with a non-irritant  control solution. Shortly after treating the ears, the animals are given various doses of the VLA-4 inhibitor by subcutaneous injection. In vivo inhibition of cell adhesion-associated inflammation is assessed by measuring the ear swelling response of the animal in the treated versus untreated ear. Swelling is measured using calipers or other suitable instrument to measure ear thickness. In this manner, one may identify those inhibitors of this invention which are best suited for inhibiting inflammation.



   Another in vivo assay that may be employed to test the inhibitors of this invention is the sheep asthma assay. This assay is performed essentially as described in W. M. Abraham et al., "a-Integrins Mediate Antigen-induced Late Bronchial
Responses and Prolonged Airway Hyperresponsiveness in Sheep",   J.   



  Clin. Invest., 93, pp. 776-87 (1994), the disclosure of which is herein incorporated by reference. This assay measures inhibition of Ascaris antigen-induced late phase airway responses and airway hyperresponsiveness in allergic sheep.



   The compounds of this invention may also be tested in a platelet aggregation assay.



   The compounds of the present invention may be used in the form of pharmaceutically acceptable salts derived from inorganic or organic acids and bases. Included among such acid salts are the following: acetate, adipate, alginate, aspartate, benzoate, benzenesulfonate, bisulfate, butyrate, citrate, camphorate, camphorsulfonate, cyclopentanepropionate, digluconate, dodecylsulfate, ethanesulfonate, fumarate, glucoheptanoate, glycerophosphate, hemisulfate, heptanoate, hexanoate, hydrochloride, hydrobromide, hydroiodide, 2  hydroxyethanesulfonate, lactate, maleate, methanesulfonate, 2naphthalenesulfonate, nicotinate, oxalate, pamoate, pectinate, persulfate, 3-phenyl-propionate, picrate, pivalate, propionate, succinate, tartrate, thiocyanate, tosylate and undecanoate.



  Base salts include ammonium salts, alkali metal salts, such as sodium and potassium salts, alkaline earth metal salts, such as calcium and magnesium salts, salts with organic bases, such as dicyclohexylamine salts, N-methyl-D-glucamine, tris(hydroxymethyl)methylamine and salts with amino acids such as arginine, lysine, and so forth. Also, the basic nitrogencontaining groups can be quaternized with such agents as lower alkyl halides, such as methyl, ethyl, propyl, and butyl chloride, bromides and iodides; dialkyl sulfates, such as dimethyl, diethyl, dibutyl and diamyl sulfates, long chain halides such as decyl, lauryl, myristyl and stearyl chlorides, bromides and iodides, aralkyl halides, such as benzyl and phenethyl bromides and others. Water or oil-soluble or dispersible products are thereby obtained.



   The compounds of the present invention may be formulated into pharmaceutical compositions that may be administered orally, parenterally, by inhalation spray, topically, rectally, nasally, buccally, vaginally or via an implanted reservoir. The term "parenteral" as used herein includes subcutaneous, intravenous, intramuscular, intraarticular, intra-synovial, intrasternal, intrathecal, intrahepatic, intralesional and intracranial injection or infusion techniques.



   The pharmaceutical compositions of this invention comprise any of the compounds of the present invention, or  pharmaceutically acceptable derivatives thereof, together with any pharmaceutically acceptable carrier. The term "carrier" as used herein includes acceptable adjuvants and vehicles.



  *Pharmaceutically acceptable carriers that may be used in the pharmaceutical compositions of this invention include, but are not limited to, ion exchangers, alumina, aluminum stearate, lecithin, serum proteins, such as human serum albumin, buffer substances such as phosphates, glycine, sorbic acid, potassium sorbate, partial glyceride mixtures of saturated vegetable fatty acids, water, salts or electrolytes, such as protamine sulfate, disodium hydrogen phosphate, potassium hydrogen phosphate, sodium chloride, zinc salts, colloidal silica, magnesium trisilicate, polyvinyl pyrrolidone, cellulose-based substances, polyethylene glycol, sodium carboxymethylcellulose, polyacrylates, waxes, polyethylene-polyoxypropylene-block polymers, polyethylene glycol and wool fat.



   According to this invention, the pharmaceutical compositions may be in the form of a sterile injectable preparation, for example a sterile injectable aqueous or oleaginous suspension. This suspension may be formulated according to techniques known in the art using suitable dispersing or wetting agents and suspending agents. The sterile injectable preparation may also be a sterile injectable solution or suspension in a non-toxic parenterally-acceptable diluent or solvent, for example as a solution in 1,3-butanediol. Among the acceptable vehicles and solvents that may be employed are water,
Ringer's solution and isotonic sodium chloride solution. In
 addition, sterile, fixed oils are conventionally employed as a
 solvent or suspending medium. For this purpose, any bland fixed  oil may be employed including synthetic mono- or di-glycerides.



  Fatty acids, such as oleic acid and its glyceride derivatives are useful in the preparation of injectables, as do natural pharmaceutically-acceptable oils, such as olive oil or castor oil, especially in their polyoxyethylated versions. These oil solutions or suspensions may also contain a long-chain alcohol diluent or dispersant, such as Ph. Helv or similar alcohol.



   The pharmaceutical compositions of this invention may be orally administered in any orally acceptable dosage form including, but not limited to, capsules, tablets, aqueous suspensions or solutions.



  In the case of tablets for oral use, carriers which are commonly used include lactose and corn starch. Lubricating agents, such as magnesium stearate, are also typically added. For oral administration in a capsule form, useful diluents include lactose and dried corn starch. When aqueous suspensions are required for oral use, the active ingredient is combined with emulsifying and suspending agents. If desired, certain sweetening, flavoring or coloring agents may also be added.



   Alternatively, the pharmaceutical compositions of this invention may be administered in the form of suppositories for rectal administration. These can be prepared by mixing the agent with a suitable non-irritating excipient which is solid at room temperature but liquid at the rectal temperature and therefore will melt in the rectum to release the drug. Such materials include cocoa butter, beeswax and polyethylene glycols.



   The pharmaceutical compositions of this invention may also be administered topically, especially when the target of  treatment includes areas or organs readily accessible by topical application, including diseases of the eye, the skin, or the lower intestinal tract. Suitable topical formulations are readily prepared for each of these areas or organs.



   Topical application for the lower intestinal tract can be effected in a rectal suppository formulation (see above) or in a suitable enema formulation. Topically-transdermal patches may also be used.



   For topical applications, the pharmaceutical compositions may be formulated in a suitable ointment containing the active component suspended or dissolved in one or more carriers. Carriers for topical administration of the compounds of this invention include, but are not limited to, mineral oil, liquid petrolatum, white petrolatum, propylene glycol, polyoxyethylene, polyoxypropylene compound, emulsifying wax and water. Alternatively, the pharmaceutical compositions can be formulated in a suitable lotion or cream containing the active components suspended or dissolved in one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers. Suitable carriers include, but are not limited to, mineral oil, sorbitan monostearate, polysorbate 60, cetyl esters wax, cetearyl alcohol, 2-octyldodecanol, benzyl alcohol and water.



   For ophthalmic use, the pharmaceutical compositions may be formulated as micronized suspensions in isotonic, pH adjusted sterile saline, or, preferably, as solutions in isotonic, pH adjusted sterile saline, either with our without a preservative such as benzylalkonium chloride. Alternatively, for ophthalmic uses, the pharmaceutical compositions may be
 formulated in an ointment such as petrolatum.  



   The pharmaceutical compositions of this invention may also be administered by nasal aerosol or inhalation through the use of a nebulizer, a dry powder inhaler or a metered dose inhaler. Such compositions are prepared according to techniques well-known in the art of pharmaceutical formulation and may be prepared as solutions in saline, employing benzyl alcohol or other suitable preservatives, absorption promoters to enhance bioavailability, fluorocarbons, and/or other conventional solubilizing or dispersing agents.



   The amount of active ingredient that may be combined with the carrier materials to produce a single dosage form will vary depending upon the host treated, and the particular mode of administration. It should be understood, however, that a specific dosage and treatment regimen for any particular patient will depend upon a variety of factors, including the activity of the specific compound employed, the age, body weight, general health, sex, diet, time of administration, rate of excretion, drug combination, and the judgment of the treating physician and the severity of the particular disease being treated. The amount of active ingredient may also depend upon the therapeutic or prophylactic agent, if any, with which the ingredient is coadministered.



   The dosage and dose rate of the compounds of this invention effective to prevent, suppress or inhibit cell adhesion will depend on a variety of factors, such as the nature of the inhibitor, the size of the patient, the goal of the treatment, the nature of the pathology to be treated, the specific pharmaceutical composition used, and the judgment of the treating physician. Dosage levels of between about 0.001  and about 100 mg/kg body weight per day, preferably between about 0.1 and about 10 mg/kg body weight per day of the active ingredient compound are useful.



   According to another embodiment compositions containing a compound of this invention may also comprise an additional agent selected from the group consisting of corticosteroids, bronchodilators, antiasthmatics (mast cell stabilizers), antiinflammatories, antirheumatics, immunosuppressants, antimetabolites, immunomodulators, antipsoriatics and antidiabetics. Specific compounds within each of these classes may be selected from any of those listed under the appropriate group headings in "Comprehensive Medicinal
Chemistry", Pergamon Press, Oxford, England, pp. 970-986 (1990), the disclosure of which is herein incorporated by reference.



  Also included within this group are compounds such as theophylline, sulfasalazine and aminosalicylates (antiinflammatories); cyclosporin, FK-506, and rapamycin (immunosuppressants); cyclophosphamide and methotrexate (antimetabolites); steroids (inhaled , oral or topical) and interferons (immunomodulators).



   According to other embodiments, the invention provides methods for preventing, inhibiting or suppressing cell adhesionassociated inflammation and cell adhesion-associated immune or autoimmune responses. VLA4-associated cell adhesion plays a central role in a variety of inflammation, immune and autoimmune diseases.

   Thus, inhibition of cell adhesion by the compounds of this invention may be utilized in methods of treating or preventing inflammatory, immune and autoimmune diseases including, but not limited to arthritis, asthma, allergies,  adult respiratory distress syndrome, cardiovascular disease, thrombosis or harmful platelet aggregation, allograft rejection, neoplastic disease, psoriasis, multiple sclerosis, CNS inflammation, Crohn's disease, ulcerative colitis, glomerular nephritis and related inflammatory renal disease, diabetes, ocular inflammation (such as uveitis), atherosclerosis, inflammatory and autoimmune diseases. This invention also provides pharmaceutical formulations containing these VLA-4mediated cell adhesion inhibitors and methods of using the compounds and compositions of the invention for inhibition of cell adhesion.

   Preferably the diseases to be treated with the methods of this invention are selected from asthma, arthritis, allergies, adult respiratory disress syndrome, cardiovascular disease, thrombosis or harmful platelet aggregation, allograft rejection, neoplastic disease, psoriasis, multiple sclerosis,
CNS inflammation, Crohn's disease, ocular inflammation (such as uveitis), artherosclerosis, psoriasis, transplantation rejection, multiple sclerosis, diabetes and inflammatory bowel disease.



   These methods may employ the compounds of this invention in a monotherapy or in combination with an antiinflammatory or immunosuppressive agent. Such combination therapies include administration of the agents in a single dosage form or in multiple dosage forms administered at the same time or at different times.  



  Prep. of AX7
A)
 To a solution of    -alanine    t-butyl ester (67 mg, 0.124 mmol) in NMP (20 mL) at   0      OC    was slowly added a solution of benzyl 2-bromoacetate in NMP (10   mL).    The reaction mixture was stirred at   0      OC    for 4 h and RT for 6 h. The mixture was diluted with EtOAc (150 mL), washed with water (50 mL x 2), sat. NaCl (30 mL) and dried with Na2SO4. After removal of excess solvent, the residue was purified by flash chromatography using hexanes/EtOAc (1:1) as the eluent to give 210 mg (72%) of the amine. To a solution of this amine (160 mg, 0.55 mmol) in CH2Cl2
 (20 mL) at 5   OC    was added p-anisoyl chloride dropwise in the presence of Et3N (167 mg; 1.65 mmol).

   After stirring at RT for 18 h, the mixture was diluted with Et2O (150 mL), washed with   5k    citric acid (30 mL), sat.   NaHCO2    (30 mL), sat. NaCl (30 mL) and dried with Na2SO4. After removal of excess solvent, the residue was purified by flash chromatography using hexane/EtOAc (2:1) as the eluent to give 230 mg (98%) of the desired product 1H NMR (CDCl3, 300 MHz, ppm) 7.33 (m, 7 H, Ar), 6.80 (m, 2 H, Ar), 5.15 (s, 2 H,   Bn),    4.19 (m, 2 H), 3.79 (s, 3 H, OMe), 2.62 (m, 2 H), 2.55 (m, 2 H), 1.40 (s, 9 H); TLC, hexanes/EtOAc (1:1), Rf = 0.43.



  B)
 The compound from step A (170 mg; 0.4 mmol),   10W    Pd(OH)2 (140   mg,    0.1 mmol) and EtOAc (30 mL) were stirred at RT under a
H2 (1 atm) atmosphere for 18 h. The mixture was filtered and the filtrate was concentrated at reduced pressure to give 100 mg
 (74%) of the desired compound 1H NMR   (CDCl3,    300 MHz, ppm) 7.32  
 (m, 2 H, Ar), 6.88 (m, 2 H, Ar), 4.16 (m, 2 H), 3.79 (s, 3 H,
OMe), 3.67 (m, 2 H), 2.56 (m, 2 H), 1.40 (s, 9 H); TLC, 10% MeOH in CH2Cl2, Rf = 0.09.



  C)
 The compound from step B (50 mg, 0.148 mmol) in DMF (1.0 mL) was activated with   EDCHCl(34    mg, 0.178 mmol) for 15 min.



  The activated acid was coupled with (33 mg, 0.148 mmol) at RT for 18 h. The mixture was diluted with EtOAc, washed with 5% citric acid, sat.   NaHCO3,    and dried with Na2SO4. The organic layer was concentrated under reduced pressure to give 67 mg
 (84%) of the desired compound ÚH NMR (DMSO-d6, 300 MHz, ppm) 9.60-6.61 (m, 10 H, Ar+NH), 4.25-3.30 (m, 9 H), 3.13-2.48 (m, 4
H), 1.54 (m, 2 H), 1.34 (s, 9 H), 1.18 (m, 1 H), 0.84 (m, 6 H);
MS, m/z 540 (C26H33N306 of M++1 requires 540).



  D)
 A solution of the compound from step C (67 mg, 0.124 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (5 mL) was treated with TFA (5 mL). The reaction mixture was stirred at RT for 6 h, then concentrated under vacuum. The crude product was purified on a Vydac reverse-phase
C18 column (22 mm x 25 cm) using a linear gradient of 15   W   
CH3CN/H2O (0.1 % TFA) to 40 %   CH3CN/H2O (0.1    % TFA) with a flow rate of 10 mL/min to give AX7 (10.0 mg, 17% isolated yield): ÚH
NMR (DMSO-d6, 300 MHz, ppm) 9.94 (m, 1 H), 7.59-6.91 (m, 9 H), 4.36-4.03 (m, 4 H), 3.76 (s, 3 H, OMe), 3.53-3.11 (m, 4 H), 2.59
 (m, 2 H), 1.52-0.71 (m, 9 H); MS, m/z 484   (C26H33N3O6    of   M +1    requires 484).  



  Prep. of   BX17   
A)
 To a solution of 2-methylamine-5-iodobenzoic acid (6.93 g; 25 mmol) and Na2CO3 (2.65 g) in water (70 mL) was added dropwise a solution of phosgene in toluene (1.93 M; 20 mL; 38.5 mmol).



  After stirring at RT for 4 h, the reaction mixture was filtered and the solids were collected. The solids were washed with water (100 mL x 2) and dried to afford 5.9 g (78%) of the desired product. A mixture of the above solid (5.33 g, 17.6 mmol),   :-alanine    ethyl ester hydrochloride (3.07 g; 20 mmol),
Et3N (2.23 g, 22 mmol) and 4-dimethyl aminopyridine (50 mg; 0.41 mmol) in DMF (50 mL) was heated at 60   OC    for 2 h. The mixture was concentrated in vacuo and the residue was diluted with EtOAc
 (90 mL), washed with water, sat. NaHCO3, and sat.

   NaCl and dried with   Na2504.    After removal of excess solvent, 5.7 g (86%) of the desired compound was obtained: 1H NMR (CDCl3, 300 MHz, ppm) 7.527.46 (m, 2 H, Ar+NH), 6.67 (s, 1 H, NH), 6.40 (d, J = 8.7 Hz, 1
H, Ar), 4.14 (q, J = 7.2 Hz, 2 H), 3.61 (q, J = 6.0 Hz, 2 H), 2.79 (s, 3 H, N-Me), 2.58 (t, J = 6.0 Hz, 3 H), 1.24 (t, J = 7.1
Hz, 3 H); MS, m/z 399   (Cl3Hl7N203I    of   M++Na    requires 399).



  B)
 A mixture of the compound from step A (3.76 g; 10 mmol), abromoacetyl bromide (3.03 g; 15 mmol), CH2C12 (25 mL) and water
 (25 mL) was stirred at RT for 2 h. After separation, the organic layer was washed with 5% citric acid, and sat. NaHCO3 and dried with Na2SO4. After removal of excess solvent, 4.2 g (85%) of the desired compound was obtained: 1H NMR (CDCl3, 300 MHz, ppm) 7.87  7.80 (m, 2 H, Ar), 7.06 (d, J = 8.2 Hz, 1 H, Ar), 6.75 (s, 1 H,
NH), 4.12 (q, J = 7.1 Hz, 2 H), 3.73-3.57 (m, 4 H), 3.14 (s, 3
H, N-Me), 2.56 (t, J = 5.8 Hz, 3 H), 1.22 (t, J = 7.1 Hz, 3 H).



  C)
 A mixture of the compound from step B (3.1 g; 6.24 mmol) and Cs2CO3 (3.05 g; 9.36 mmol) in DMF (20 mL) was stirred at RT under nitrogen for 2 h. The mixture was diluted with EtOAc (90 mL), washed with water, 5% citric acid, and sat. NaHCO3 and dried with Na2SO4. After removal of excess solvent, the residue was purified by flash chromatography using hexane/EtOAc (1:2) as the eluent to give 1.65 g (64%) of the desired compound : 1H NMR (DMSO-d6, 300 MHz, ppm) 8.29 (d, J = 1.8 Hz, 1 H), 7.76 (m, 1 H), 6.90 (d, J = 8.6 Hz, 1 H), 4.10 (q, J = 7.1 Hz, 2 H), 4.04-3.83 (m, 4 H), 3.32 (s, 3 H, N-Me), 2.77-2.56 (m, 2 H), 1.22 (t, J = 7.1 Hz, 3 H); TLC, hexane/EtOAc (1:1) , Rf = 0.22.



  D)
 A mixture of the compound from step C (100 mg; 0.24 mmol), 2-methyl phenylureaphenylamine (87 mg; 0.36 mmol),   PdCl2(PPh3)2    (17 mg; 0.024 mmol) and Bu3N (89 mg, 0.48 mmol) in DMF (10 mL) was heated at 100   OC    under CO (1 atm) for 18 h. The mixture was diluted with EtOAc (90 mL), washed with 5% citric acid, and sat.



  NaHCO3 and dried with Na2SO4. After removal of excess solvent, the residue was purified by flash chromatography using 5% MeOH in CH2Cl2 as the eluent to give 40 mg (30%) of the desired compound : ÚH NMR (DMSO-d6, 300 MHz, ppm) 9.18 (s, 1 H), 8.55 (s, 1 H), 8.19 (d, J = 8.5 Hz, 1 H), 7.69 (s, 1 H), 7.41 (d, J = 8.3
Hz, 3 H), 7.24-7.09 (m, 7 H), 4.10 (t, J = 7.1 Hz, 2 H), 4.01  3.85 (m, 4 H), 3.36 (s, 3 H, N-Me), 2.70-2.59 (m, 2 H), 2.24 (s, 3 H, Me), 1.22 (t, J = 7.1 Hz, 3 H); MS, m/z 580 (C30H31N506 of
M++Na requires 580); TLC, 5% MeOH in CH2C12, Rf = 0.56.



  E)
 A solution of the compound from step D (20 mg, 0.036 mmol) in MeOH (4 mL) was treated with aqueous LiOH (2N, 2 mL). The reaction mixture was stirred at RT for 2 h, then acidified with
TFA (until pH = 5-6). The product was purified on a Vydac reverse-phase C18 column (22 mm x 25 cm) using a linear gradient of 15   k    CH3CN/H2O (0.1 % TFA) to 27% CH3CN/H2O (0.1        TFA) with a flow rate of 10 mL/min to give   BX17    (12.0 mg,   63t    isolated yield):

   1H NMR (DMSO-d6, 300 MHz, ppm) 9.02 (s, 1 H), 8.34 (s, 1
H), 8.16 (d, J = 8.5 Hz, 1 H), 7.91-6.90 (m, 11 H), 4.11-3.75
 (m, 4 H), 3.33 (s, 3 H, N-Me), 2.88-2.56 (m, 2 H), 2.24 (s, 3 H,   Me);    MS, m/z 530   (C28H27NsO6    of   M +1    requires 530)
Prep. of BX31
A)
 To a solution of 3-methyl-4-nitrobenzoic acid (3.62 g, 20 mmol) in pyridine (48 mL) at RT was added benzene sulfonyl chloride (7.1 g, 40 mmol). After stirring for 10 min, the mixture was cooled to 5   OC    and t-butyl alcohol (4.44 g, 60 mmol) was added. The resulting mixture was stirred at RT for 2 h.



  The mixture was poured into a mixture of ice and water (200 mL; 1:1). The solids were collected and washed with water (30 mL x 3). After drying under vacuum, 4.6 g   (97)    of the ester was obtained.  



   To a solution of the above ester (3.55 g, 15 mmol) in CC14
 (50 mL) at RT was added N-bromosuccinimide (2.94 g, 16.5 mmol) and benzoxyl peroxide (182 mg, 0.75 mmol). The mixture was refluxed for 18 h. After removal of excess solvent, the residue was purified by flash chromatography using hexanes/EtOAc (19:1) as the eluent to give 1.90 g   (40k)    of the bromide as a yellow oil.



   A solution of the bromide (1.57 g, 10 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (20 ml) was added to a solution of methyl amine (2 N in THF; 30 mL; 60 mmol) at RT over a period of 60 min. The resulting mixture was stirred at RT for 18 h and then concentrated in vacuo. The residue was dissolved in CH2Cl2 (80 mL), washed with sat. NaHCO3
 (20 mL), and sat.   NaCl    (20 mL) and dried with Na2SO4. After removal of excess solvent, the residue was purified by flash chromatography using hexanes/EtOAc (1:1) as the eluent to give 810 mg   (61W)    of the desired compound as light yellow oil : 1H NMR
   (CDCl3,    300 MHz, ppm) 8.47 (s, 1 H), 8.15 (d, J = 8.0 Hz, 1 H), 7.69 (d, J = 8.0 Hz, 1 H), 4.02 (s, 2 H, Bn), 2.43 (s, 3 H, Me), 1.62 (s, 1 H, NH), 1.58 (s, 9 H); TLC, hexanes/EtOAc (1:1), Rf = 0.27.



  B)
 A mixture of the compound from step A (810 mg; 3.05 mmol), di-t-butyl dicarbonate (1.33 g, 6.1 mmol) and Et3N (926 mg, 9.15 mmol) in CH2C12 (50 mL) was stirred for 18 h. The mixture was diluted with CH2Cl2 (50 mL), washed with   5    citric acid, and sat.



  NaHCO3 and dried with   Na2504.    After removal of excess solvent, the residue was purified by flash chromatography using  hexanes/EtOAc (3:1) as the eluent to give 1.06 g (95%) of the product.



   A mixture of protected amine (1.06 g; 2.9 mmol), 10% Pd/C
 (300 mg, 0.28 mmol) and EtOH (40 mL) was stirred at RT under a H2
 (50 psi) atmosphere for 18 h. The mixture was filtered and the filtrate was concentrated at reduced pressure. The residue was purified by flash chromatography using hexanes/EtOAc (4:1) as the eluent to give 620 mg (64%) of the desired compound: 1H NMR
   (CDCl31    300 MHz, ppm) 7.72-7.65 (m, 2 H, Ar), 6.56 (d, J = 8.3
Hz, 1 H, Ar), 5.06 (s, 2 H, NH), 4.32 (s, 2 H, Bn), 2.73 (s, 3
H, Me), 1.55 (s, 9 H), 1.45 (s, 9 H); TLC, hexanes/EtOAc (3:1),
Rf = 0.49.



  C)
 A mixture of the compound from step B (0.62 g; 1.84 mmol) and dimethyl acetylene dicarboxylate (275 mg; 1.93 mmol) in MeOH
 (30 mL) was refluxed under a nitrogen atmosphere for 1 h.



  After removal of excess solvent, 0.85 g (96%) of the adducts was obtained. A mixture of these adducts (0.85 g, 1.78 mmol), 10%
Pd/C (300 mg, 0.28 mmol) and EtOH (40 mL) was stirred at RT under a H2 (40 psi) atmosphere for 5 h. The mixture was filtered and the filtrate was concentrated at reduced pressure.



  The residue was purified by flash chromatography using hexanes/EtOAc (3:1) as the eluent to afford 0.75 g   (88W)    of reduced product.



   A solution of the above reduced product (0.99 g, 2.06 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (30 mL) at RT was treated with TFA (10 mL). The reaction mixture was stirred for 2 h. The mixture was concentrated at reduced pressure to afford 0.68 g (99%) of the desired product as the TFA salt:   111    NMR (DMSO-d6, 300 MHz, ppm)  8.57 (s, 1 H, NH), 7.89 (s, 1 H, Ar), 7.79 (d, J = 9.0 Hz, 1 H,
Ar), 6.76 (d, J = 8.8 Hz, 1 H, Ar), 6.34 (d, J = 8.6 Hz, 1 H,
NH), 4.64 (m, 1 H), 3.64 (s, 3 H, Me), 3.61 (s, 3 H, Me), 3.052.87 (m, 2 H), 2.43 (s, 3 H, N-Me); MS, m/z 325 (C15H20N206 of M+1 requires 325); TLC, 10% MeOH in CH2Cl2, Rf = 0.13.



  D)
 A mixture of the compound from step C (200 mg; 0.62 mmol) and NaOMe (0.5 N; 2.47 mL; 1.23 mmol) in MeOH (30 mL) was refluxed under a nitrogen atmosphere for 5 h. After cooling to 0  C, HCl (1 N, 2 mL) was added. After removal of excess solvent, the residue was purified by flash chromatography using
MeOH/CH2Cl2 (1:9) as the eluent to give 110 mg (82   t)    of the desired acid as a light yellow solid: 1H NMR (DMSO-d6, 300 MHz, ppm) 7.58 (s, 1 H, Ar), 7.53 (d, J = 8.5 Hz, 1 H, Ar), 6.62 (s, 1 H, NH), 6.56 (d, J = 8.5 Hz, 1 H, Ar), 5.45 (d, J = 16.4 Hz, 1
H, Bn), 5.16 (s, 1 H), 3.92 (d, J = 16.6 Hz, 1 H, Bn), 3.59 (s, 3 H, Me), 2.90 (s, 3 H, Me), 2.76 (m, 2 H); MS, m/z 293
   (C14Hl6N205    of M+1 requires 293); TLC, 10% MeOH in CH2Cl2, Rf = 0.47.



  E)
 The acid from step D(45 mg, 0.154 mmol) in DMF (1.0 mL) was
 activated with   EDC HCl    (35.5 mg, 0.185 mmol) for 15 min. The activated acid was coupled with 2-methylphenylureaphenylamine
 (41 mg, 0.169 mmol) at RT for 72 h. The mixture was diluted with EtOAc, washed with 5% citric acid, and sat. NaHCO3 and dried with Na2SO4. The organic solution was concentrated under reduced pressure to give the desired compound in 82% yield: 1H NMR  
 (DMSO-d6, 300 MHz, ppm) 9.70-6.40 (m, 15 H), 5.50 (m, 1 H, Bn), 5.11 (m, 1 H), 3.90 (m, 1 H, Bn), 3.60 (s, 3 H, OMe), 2.92 (s, 3
H, Me), 2.81-2.48 (m, 2 H), 2.23 (s, 3 H,   Me);    MS, m/z 538
 (C28H29N505 of M+Na requires 538).

 

  F)
 A solution of the compound from step E (65   mg,    0.13 mmol) in MeOH (3 mL) was treated with aqueous LiOH (2 N, 1 mL). The reaction mixture was stirred at RT for 2 h, then acidified with
TFA (until pH = 5-6). The product was purified on a Vydac reverse-phase C18 column (22 mm x 25 cm) using a linear gradient of 15   k    CH3CN/H2O (0.1 % TFA) to 32% CH3CN/H2O (0.1   W    TFA) with a flow rate of 10 mL/min to give BX31 (15 mg, 23% isolate 3). After drying under vacuum, 12.5 g   (96W)    of ester was obtained.



   To a solution of the above ester (7.1 g, 30 mmol) in CC14
 (50 mL) at RT was added N-bromosuccinimide (5.88 g, 32 mmol) and benzoxyl peroxide (727 mg, 3 mmol). The mixture was refluxed for 18 h. After removal of excess solvent, the residue was purified by flash chromatography using hexanes/EtOAc (19:1) as the eluent to give 8.0 g (91%) of the bromide as a yellow oil.



  A solution of the bromide (3.16 g, 10 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (20 ml) was added to a solution of methyl amine (2 N in THF; 30 mL; 60 mmol) at RT over a period of 60 min. The resulting mixture was stirred at RT for 18 h and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was dissolved in CH2Cl2 (80 mL), washed with sat. NaHCO3 (20 mL), and sat. NaCl (20 mL) and dried with Na2SO4. After removal of excess solvent, the residue was purified by flash chromatography using hexanes/EtOAc (1:1) as the eluent to give 1.43 g   (54t)    of the desired amine as a light yellow oil:   H    NMR (CDC13, 300 MHz, ppm) 8.47 (s, 1 H), 8.15 (d, J = 8.0 Hz, 1 H), 7.69 (d, J = 8.0
Hz, 1 H), 4.02 (s, 2 H, Bn), 2.43 (s, 3 H, Me), 1.62 (s, 1 H,
NH), 1.58 (s, 9   H);    TLC, 10% MeOH in CH2Cl2, Rf = 0.49.



  B)
 A mixture of the compound from step A (1.09 g; 3.45 mmol), di-t-butyl dicarbonate (1.5 g, 6.9 mmol) and Et3N (1.05 g, 10.35 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (50 mL) was stirred for 18 h. The mixture was diluted with CH2Cl2 (50 mL), washed with 5% citric acid, and sat.



  NaHCO3 and dried with   Na2504.    After removal of excess solvent, the residue was purified by flash chromatography using  hexane/EtOAc (3:1) as the eluent to give 1.16 g   (92k)    of the product.



   A mixture of the protected amine (1.16 g; 3.17 mmol), 10%
Pd/C (300 mg, 0.28 mmol) and EtOH (40 mL) was stirred at RT under a H2 (50 psi) atmosphere for 18 h. The mixture was filtered and the filtrate was concentrated at reduced pressure.



  The residue was purified by flash chromatography using hexanes/EtOAc (4:1) as the eluent to give 0.78 g   (73k)    of the desired compound: 1H NMR (CDC13, 300 MHz, ppm) 7.25-7.0 (m, 3 H,
Ar), 4.60 (s, 2 H, NH), 4.34 (s, 2 H, Bn), 2.71 (s, 3 H, Me), 1.54 (s, 9 H), 1.45 (s, 9 H); TLC, hexanes/EtOAc (4:1), Rf = 0.29.



  C)
 A mixture of the compound from step B (0.78 g; 2.32 mmol) and dimethyl acetylene dicarboxylate (363 mg; 2.55 mmol) in MeOH
 (30 mL) was refluxed under a nitrogen atmosphere for 2 h. After removal of excess solvent, 1.05 g   (95 )    of the adducts was obtained. A mixture of these adducts (1.05 g, 2.2 mmol), 10%
Pd/C (300 mg, 0.28 mmol) and EtOH (40 mL) was stirred at RT under a H2 (50 psi) atmophere for 6 h. The mixture was filtered and the filtrate was concentrated at reduced pressure to afford 0.99 g   (94t)    of the reduced product.



   A solution of the above reduced product (0.99 g, 2.06 mmol) in CH2C12 (30 mL) at RT was treated with TFA (15 mL). The reaction was stirred for 4 h. The mixture was concentrated at reduced pressure to afford 0.90 g   (99W)    of the desired compound as the TFA salt:   1H    NMR   (DMSO-d6,    300 MHz, ppm) 8.63 (s, 1 H), 7.37-7.26 (m, 3 H, Ar), 5.96 (d, J = 8.8 Hz, 1H, NH), 4.53 (m, 1  
H), 4.15 (m, 2H, Bn), 3.64 (s, 3 H, Me), 3.62 (s, 3 H, Me), 3.04-2.85 (m, 2 H), 2.57 (s, 3 H, Me); TLC, 10% MeOH in CH2C12,
Rf = 0.22.



  D)
 A mixture of the compound from step C (550 mg; 1.70 mmol) and NaOMe (0.5 N; 6.8 mL; 3.4 mmol) in MeOH (60 mL) was refluxed under a nitrogen atmosphere overnight. After cooling to   0    EC,
HCl (1 N, 5 mL) was added. After removal of excess solvent, the residue was purified by flash chromatography using MeOH/CH2Cl2
 (1:9) as the eluent to give 200 mg (40%) of the desired acid as a light yellow solid: 1H NMR   (DMSO-d6,    300 MHz, ppm) 7.18 (s, 1
H, Ar), 7.04 (s, 2 H, Ar), 6.17 (s, 1 H, NH), 5.47 (t, J = 6.6, 1 H), 5.07 (m, 3 H, OMe), 3.89 (d, J = 6.6 Hz, 2 H), 3.58 (s, 3
H, Me), 2.89 (s, 3 H, Me), 2.83-2.60 (s, 2 H); MS, m/z 291
   (Cl4Hl6N205    of M-1 requires 291); TLC, 10% MeOH in CH2C12, Rf = 0.22.



  E)
 The acid from step D (50 mg, 0.17 mmol) in DMF (0.5 mL) was activated with EDC (39 mg, 0.204 mmol) for 15 min. The activated acid was coupled with 2-methylphenylureaphenylamine
 (45 mg, 0.188 mmol) at RT for 96 h. The mixture was diluted with EtOAc, washed with 5% citric acid, and sat. NaHCO3 and dried with Na2SO4. The organic solution was concentrated under reduced pressure to give the desired compound in 10% yield: 1H NMR (DMSOd6, 300 MHz, ppm) 9.97-8.57 (m, 2 H), 7.95-6.50 (m, 12 H), 6.10
 (m,   1H),    5.50 (m, 1 H,   Bn),    4.98 (m, 1 H), 3.90 (m, 1 H, Bn),  3.58 (s, 3 H, OMe), 2.90 (s, 3 H, Me), 2.89-2.55 (m, 2 H), 2.20
 (s, 3 H,   Me);    MS, m/z 538   (C28H29NsOs    of M+Na requires 538).



  F)
 A solution of the compound from step E (9.0 mg, 0.017 mmol) in MeOH (3 mL) was treated with aqueous LioH (2 N, 1 mL). The reaction mixture was stirred at RT for 2 h, then acidified with
TFA (until pH = 5-6). The product was purified on a Vydac reverse-phase C18 column (22 mm x 25 cm) using a linear gradient of 15 % CH3CN/H2O (0.1   k    TFA) to 32% CH3CN/H2O (0.1 % TFA) with a flow rate of 10 mL/min to give BX36 (3.0 mg, 35% isolated yield): 1H NMR (DMSO-d6, 300 MHz, ppm) 9.98 (s, 1 H), 8.98 (s, 1
H), 7.89-6.92 (m, 12 H), 6.06 (s, 1 H), 5.48 (d, J = 6.6 Hz, 1
H), 5.03 (m, 1 H), 3.89 (d, J = 6.6 Hz, 1 H), 2.91 (s, 3 H,
NMe), 2.75-2.53 (m, 2 H), 2.23 (s, 3 H, Me); MS, m/z 502
   (C27H27N5Os    of   M++l    requires 502)
Preparation of BX47
A.

   A slurry of N-methylisatoic anhydride (10.12 g, 57.15 mmol) and glycine (4.29 g, 57.17 mmol) in glacial acetic acid (125 mL) was heated at 120   OC    for 3.5 h. The reaction solution was then concentrated in vacuo to a thick oil and ether (100 mL) was added. The resulting solids were filtered, rinsed with ether and air dried to give 8.80 g of a tan solid. The solid was slurried with CHCl3 (250 mL) for 1 h. The solution was filtered and the filtrate was concentrated in vacuo to give 7.43 g (68% yield) of a tan solid identified as the desired product: MS
 (ESP+) 190.9 m/z; 1H NMR   (CDCl3,    300 MHz, ppm) 3.38 (s, 3H),  3.78-3.83 (m, 2H), 6.85 (br t, 1H), 7.20-7.34 (m, 2H), 7.52-7.58 (m, 1H), 7.88 (dd, J = 7.81, 1.65 Hz, 1H).



  B. The compound from procedure A (1.52 g, 8.01 mmol), anhydrous
CsF (1.22 g, 8.03   mmol),    tetraethyl orthosilicate (1.79 mL, 8.03 mmol) and ethyl acrylate (0.96 mL, 8.86 mmol) were slurried in anhydrous   TWF    (8.0 mL) at room temperature for 26 h.

   The reaction mixture was then filtered through Celite, the filtrate concentrated in vacuo and the resultant solid purified by flash column chromatography (CHCl3 6 10:1 CHCl3/ether) to give 1.63 g
 (70% yield) of a light yellow solid identified as the desired product: MS (ESP+) 291 m/z;   H    NMR   (CDCl3,    300 MHz, ppm) 1.24 (t,
J = 7.12 Hz, 3H), 2.60-2.78 (m, 2H), 3.37 (s, 3H), 3.94 (ABq, J = 14.86 Hz, )L = 52.41 Hz, 2H), 3.92 (t, J = 7.01 Hz, 2H), 4.13 (q, J = 7.10 Hz, 2H), 7.17 (d, J = 8.07 Hz, 1H), 7.29 (d, J = 8.57 Hz,   1H),    7.50 (dt, J = 7.78, 1.67 Hz, 1H), 7.84 (dd, J = 7.83, 1.63 Hz, 1H).



  C. The compound from procedure B (1.61 g, 5.55 mmol) was dissolved in iced fuming nitric acid (7.4   mL).    The reaction solution was allowed to slowly warm to room temperature and after 2 h poured into a mixture of saturated aqueous NaHCO3 (100 mL) /ice (100 g). The slurry was brought to neutral pH with solid   NaHCO3.    The aqueous solution was extracted with ethyl acetate (4 x 100 mL).

   The combined organic phases were washed with water (1 x 100 mL) and saturated aqueous NaCl (1 x 100 mL), dried (MgSO4) and concentrated in vacuo to give 1.83 g   (98k    yield) of a yellow oil identified as the desired product: MS (ESP+) 336, 358   m/z;      H    NMR (CDCl3, 300 MHz, ppm) 1.25 (t, J =  7.10 Hz,   3H),    2.62-2.81 (m,   2H),    3.42 (s,   3H),    3.90-3.95 (m, 2H), 4.01 (s, 2H), 4.13 (q, J = 7.17 Hz, 2H), 7.32 (d, J = 9.05
Hz, 1H), 8.33 (dd, J = 8.97, 2.70 Hz, 1H), 8.73 (d, J = 2.71 Hz,   1H).   



  D. A slurry of the compound from procedure C (1.82 g, 5.44 mmol) and  < 10 micron Fe powder (0.91 g, 16.99 mmol) in 2:1 ethanol/water (54 mL) was heated to reflux and glacial acetic acid (0.63 mL, 11.01 mmol) was added. After 2 h the hot reaction mixture was filtered through Celite and the pad washed with hot ethanol (3 x 50   mL).    The filtrate was concentrated in vacuo, dissolved in ethyl acetate (125 mL), washed with saturated aqueous NaHCO3 (2 x 40 mL), water (1 x 40 mL) and saturated aqueous NaCl ( 1 x 40 mL), dried (MgSO4) and concentrated in vacuo to give a yellow solid.

   The solid was dissolved in 1:1 CHCl3/THF, passed through a silica gel plug and concentrated in vacuo to give 1.20 g (72% yield) of a yellow foam identified as the desired product: MS (ESP+) 306.1, 328.2 m/z;   H    NMR (CDC13, 300 MHz, ppm) * 1.21(t, J = 7.13 Hz, 3H), 2.57-2.76 (m, 2H), 3.27 (s, 3H), 3.63 (br s, 1H), 3.87 (t, J = 7.25 Hz, 2H), 3.89 (ABq, J = 14.69 Hz, )L = 77.45 Hz, 2H), 4.10
 (q, J = 7.12 Hz, 2H), 6.79 (dd, J = 8.84, 2.56 Hz, 1H), 6.95(d,
J = 8.66 Hz, 1H), 7.07 (d, J = 2.56 Hz, 1H).



  E. 4-o-tolylureidophenylacetic acid (0.57 g, 2.00 mmol),   EDC HCl   
 (0.43 g, 2.24 mmol) and the compound from procedure D (0.61 g, 2.00 mmol) were dissolved in anhydrous DMF (10 mL) at room temperature under an atmosphere of nitrogen. After stirring for
 3 d the reaction was quenched with water (30 mL). The resultant  slurry was stirred for 24 h and filtered.

   The tan precipitate was washed with 5% aqueous citric acid (2 x 20 mL),   10k    aqueous
NaHCO3 (3 x 20 mL) and water (2 x 20 mL) and dried in vacuo to give 0.76 g (66% yield) of a tan solid identified as the desired product: MS (ESP+) 572.4, 594.5 m/z; 1H NMR (acetone-d6, 300 MHz, ppm) 1.19 (t, J = 7.17 Hz, 3H), 2.25 (s, 3H), 2.62-2.68 (m, 2H), 3.31   (s,    3H), 3.64 (s, 2H), 3.78-3.96 (m, 2H), 3.96 (ABq, J = 14.87 Hz, )L = 86.48 Hz, 2H), 4.07 (q, J = 7.08 Hz, 2H), 6.94
 (dd, J = 8.42, 7.51 Hz, 1H), 7.13 (dd, J = 7.90, 5.36 Hz, 2H), 7.27-7.32 (m,   3H),    7.47-7.59 (m,   3H),    7.91-7.94 (m,   3H),    8.40
 (s, 1H), 9.46 (s, 1H).



  F. 1.0 M sodium   trimethylsilanolate/CH2Cl2    (4.0 mL, 4.0 mmol) was added to a solution of the compound from procedure E (0.57 g, 0.99 mmol) in anhydrous THF (100 mL) under an atmosphere of nitrogen at room temperature. After stirring for 5 h the reaction was filtered and the precipatate washed with THF.

   The precipate was slurried with 1:1 glacial acetic acetic acid/ether
 (10 mL) for 22 h, filtered, washed with 1:1 glacial acetic acid/ether (3 x 10 mL) and ether and air dried to give 0.42 g
 (78% yield) of a white solid identified BX47: MS (ESP+) 544.2, 566.2 m/z;   H    NMR   (acetone-d6,    300 MHz, ppm)2.14 (s, 3H), 2.56
 (t, J = 7.10 Hz, 1H), 2.57 (t, J = 7.50 Hz, 1H), 3.20 (s, 3H), 3.53 (s, 2H), 3.72-3.77 (m, 2H), 3.87 (ABq, J = 15.13 Hz, )L = 75.08 Hz, 2H), 6.82-6.85 (m, 1H), 7.01-7.05 (m, 2H), 7.27 (ABq,
J = 8.59 Hz, )L = 60.76 Hz, 4H), 7.16-7.21 (m, 1H), 7.80-7.84
 (m, 3H), 8.28 (s, 1H), 9.34 (s,   1H).     



  Preparation of RX18
A. Triethylamine (0.35 mL, 2.51 mmol) was added to a slurry of   "-bromo-3-nitrotoluene    (0.22 g, 1.04 mmol) and    -ethylalanineAHCl   
 (0.19 g, 1.24 mmol) in anhydrous   TWF    (5 mL) under an atmosphere of nitrogen. The reaction was stirred at room temperature for 24 h and at 60 EC for 18 h, cooled to room temprature, diluted with ethyl acetate (50 mL), washed with water (1 x 15 mL), 5% aqueous NaHCO3 (1 x 15 mL) and saturated aqueous NaCl (1 x 15 mL), dried (MgSO4) and concentrated in vacuo to give a yellow oil.

   The oil was purified by flash column chromatography (2:1 ethyl acetate/hexanes) to give 0.22 g   (84t    yield) of a yellow oil identified as the desired product: 1H NMR (CDCl3, 300 MHz, ppm) 1.24 (t, J = 7.16 Hz, 3H), 1.68 (br s, 1H), 2.52 (t, J = 6.30 Hz, 2H), 2.88 (t, J = 6.31 Hz, 2H), 3.89 (s, 2H), 4.13 (q,
J = 7.14 Hz, 2H), 7.47 (t, J = 7.89 Hz, 1H), 7.66 (d, J = 7.52
Hz, 1H), 8.09 (d, J = 8.12 Hz, 1H), 8.02 (s, 1H).



  B. A solution of the compound from procedure A (0.072 g, 0.28 mmol), anhydrous pyridine (0.035 mL, 0.43 mmol) and benzoyl chloride (0.050 mL, 0.43 mmol) was stirred at   0      OC    for 2 h. The reaction solution was then diluted with ethyl acetate (14 mL), washed with 5% aqueous citric acid (2 x 5 mL), 10% aqueous NaHCO3
 (2 x 5 mL), water (1 x 5 mL) and saturated aqueous NaCl (1 x 5 mL), dried (MgSO4) and concentrated in vacuo to give a thick oil.



  The oil was purified by flash column chromatography (95:5 chloroform/ether) to give 0.089 g (92% yield) of a colorless oil identified as the desired product: 1H NMR   (CDCl3,    300 MHz, ppm) 1.23 (br s 3H), 2.50 (br s, 1H), 2.72 (br s,   1H),    3.65 (br s, 2H), 4.10 (br s, 2H), 4.73 (br s, 2H), 7.40 (s, 5H), 7.53 (t, J   = 7.81 Hz,   1H),    7.60 (br s,   1H),    8.00 (br s, 1H), 8.14 (d, J = 7.13 Hz, 1H).



  C. A slurry of 10% Pd/C (0.016 g, 0.15 mmol) and the compound from procedure B (0.086 g, 0.25 mmol) in 2:1 ethanol/ethyl acetate (1.8 mL) was subjected to an H2 atmosphere (60 psi) at room temperature for 18 h. The reaction was then filtered through Celite, washing the pad extensively with ethyl acetate.



  The combined washes were concentrated in vacuo to give 0.80 g (95 yield) of an orange oil identified as the desired product:
MS (ESP+) 327 m/z; 1H NMR (CDCl3, 300 MHz, ppm) the peaks were very broad but consistent with the desired product.



  D. A'solution of the product from procedure C (0.077 g, 0.24 mmol), 4-o-tolylureidophenylacetic acid (0.075 g, 0.26 mmol),
TBTU (0.089 g, 0.28 mmol) and diisopropylethylamine (0.046 mL, 0.26 mL) in NMP (0.60 mL) at room temperature under an atmosphere of nitrogen was stirred for 3 d. It was then diluted with ethyl acetate (25 mL), washed with 5% aqueous citric acid (2 x 6 mL), 5% aqueous NaHCO3 (2 x 6 mL), water (1 x 6 mL) and saturated aqueous NaCl (1 x 6 mL), dried (MgSO4) and concentrated in vacuo to give a yellow oil. The oil was purified by flash column chromatography (99:1 chloroform/methanol - 98:2 chloroform/methanol) to give 0.11 g (78% yield) of a white glass identified as the desired product: MS (ESP+) 593, 615   m/z;    1H
NMR   (CDCl3,    300 MHz, ppm) the peaks were very broad but consistent with the desired product.  



  E. A solution of the product from procedure D (0.047 g, 0.079 mmol) and lithium hydroxide hydrate (0.021 g, 0.51 mmol) in 2:1
THF/water (3 mL) was stirred at room temperature for 4 h. The reaction was then quenched with glacial acetic acid and concentrated in vacuo to give a white solid. The solid was purified by flash column chromatography (98:1:1 chloroform/ methanol/acetic acid - 94:5:1 chloroform/methanol/acetic acid) to give, after lyophilization, 0.037 g (82% yield) of a white glass identified as   RX18:    MS (ESP+) 565, 587 m/z; 1H NMR (DMSOd6, 300 MHz, ppm) 2.23   (F, 3/),    2.48-2.59 (m, 2/), 3.31-3.70 (m, 4/), 4.44 (F, 1/), 4.66 (F, 1/), 6.84-7.56 (m, 16H), 7.83 (d, J = 7.55 Hz,   1H),    7.88 (s,   1H),    8.89 (s,   1H),    10.17 (s, 1H).



  General procedure for the synthesis of 1,4-benzodiazepine-2,5diones on solid support.



  Analogs of    -Alanine.   



  A. Wang resin loaded with Fmoc-protected   D-alanine    (7.0 g, 2.8 mmol) was treated with 20% piperidine in dimethylformamide (75 mL) for 15 minutes. The resin was then washed with dimethylformamide (3x75mL), methanol (1x75mL) and dichloromethane (3x75mL). B. A solution of 2-fluoro-5nitrobenzoic acid (5.18 g, 28.0 mmol) and diisopropylcarbodiimide (4.4 mL, 28.0 mmol) in Nmethylpyrrolidinone (50 mL) was added to the resin. After the resin was mechanically shaken for over 5 hours, the resin was washed with N-methylpyrrolidinone (3xlOmL) and dichloromethane
 (3x75mL). C. The resin was separated into 14 equal (by weight)  portions and placed into separate reactors. To each reactor with resin was added a 0.20 M solution (10 mL) of a primary amine in
N-methylpyrrolidinone.

   Some representative primary amines used in this step were: Benzylamine, Phenethylamine, sec-Butylamine,
Tetrahydrofurylamine, Glycine methyl ester,   -Alanine    ethyl ester, Valine methyl ester,    -Alanine    t-butyl ester, 2-Amino 1methoxypropane, Isobutylamine, (Aminomethyl)cyclopropane, 4  Amino-l -benzylpiperidine,      4 -Fluorobenzylamine    and cyclohexylamine. Each resin was mechanically shaken for 20 hours. The resins were washed with N-methylpyrrolidinone (3x10 mL) and dichloromethane (2xlOmL). D.

   Each resin was then treated with 2.0 g (8.86 mmol) of tin(II) chloride dihydrate in 10 mL of 1/1 ethanol/N-methylpyrrolidinone for 1 hour at 80   OC.    The resins were washed with N-methylpyrrolidinone (2x10 mL),   0.5k    solution of sodium bicarbonate in 1/1 water/N-methylpyrrolidinone   (5x10    mL), N-methylpyrrolidinone   (5x10    mL) and dichloromethane. E. To each resin was added a mixture of 4-(2-tolylureido)phenylacetic acid (570 mg, 2.0 mmol) and diisopropylcarbodiimide (0.315 mL, 2 mmol) in 5 mL of N-methylpyrrolidinone. The resins were mechanically shaken for 5 hours. Then, each resin was washed with N-methylpyrrolidinone (3x10 mL) and dichloromethane (2x10   mL).    F.

   To each reactor of resin was added a 0.2 M solution of bromoacetyl bromide in N-methypyrrolidinone (10 mL) and diisopropylethylamine (0.350 mL, 2.0 mmol). After 5 hours of continuously mechanical shaking, each resin was washed with Nmethylpyrrolidinone (5x10 mL). G. To each resin was added 0.2 M solution of 1,8-diazabicyclo[5.4.0]undec-7-ene (10   mL) .    The resins were mechanically shaken for over 5 hours, washed with Nmethylpyrrolidinone (3x10 mL), dichloromethane (3x10 mL) and  then dried. H. To each resin was added a solution of trifluoroacetic acid/water, 9.5/0.5 (5.0 mL). The resins were shaken for over 30 minutes. The resins were filtered. Each acid solution was collected in a separate 50-mL centrifuge tube. To each tube was added ethyl ether (30 mL). Each tube was spun down for 5 minutes. The ether was discarded.

   The crude products
 (pellets) were purified by RP-HPLC to give the corresponding 1,4-benzodiazepine- 2,5 diones. Examples:   BX58,    MS, m/z 620;
BX52, MS, m/z 634; BX49, MS, m/z 586; BX40, MS, m/z 612; BX55,
MS, m/z 614; BX39, MZ, m/z 602;   BX57,    MS, m/z 602; BY84, MS, m/z 630; BX63, MS, m/z 644;   BX53,    MS, m/z 586; BX54, MS, m/z 602;
BX46, MS, m/z 584; BX43, MS, m/z 703;   BOX48,    MS, m/z 638.



  DL-3-Aminobutyric acid analogs.



  Exactly the same procedure as described for the    -Alanine    analogs was applied with Fmoc-DL-aminobutyric acid Wang resin
 (0.476 g, 0.20 mmol). The ratio of resin to solvents and reagents was proportional to that procedure. In step C, a 0.20 M solution of   -alanine    t-butyl ester (10 mL) in Nmethylpyrrolidinone was added to the resin. After step H was completed, there was obtained BY76, MS, m/z 616.



  General Procedures for the Synthesis of Peptoids
Procedure A
 1. To 4-nitrophenylisocyanate (60.0 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (100 mL) was added Aniline or substituted Aniline (60.0 mmol), at RT The reaction mixture was stirred at RT for 1.5 hrs. The solid urea product was filtered, washed with CH2Cl2 (3 X 100 mL) and ether
 (3 X 100 mL). Then, the urea product was air dryed.  



  Precursor to E-1:
Yield:   94W;    ÚH NMR (DMSO-d6, 300 MHz,   ppm):    8.52 (d,lH), 8.2-8.4
 (m, 2H), 7.78-7.9 (m, 4H), 7.06-7.35 (m, 1H), 2.35 (s, 3H); MS
   (FAB):    272.2.



  Precursor to E-2:
Yield:   95W;    ÚH NMR (MeOH-d4, 300 MHz, ppm): 8.4 (d,2H), 7.86 (d, 2H), 7.65 (d, 2H), 7.51 (t, 2H), 7.35 (t, 1H); MS   (FAB):    258.



   2. To the product from step A (15.0 mmol) in ethanol (30 mL), was added tin(II) chloride dihydrate (45.0 mmol, Aldrich) and the resulting mixture was refluxed at 75   C    (using an oil bath) for 2.5 hrs. The reaction mixture was cooled down with an ice bath and 1N   HC1    was added to acidify the solution. The acidified reaction mixture was washed with EtOAc (3 X 100 mL).



  The aqueous extracts were combined and the pH was brought to 1012, using saturated K2CO3 solution. This was extracted with EtOAc
 (3 X 100 mL). The EtOAc extracts were combined and washed with saturated NaHCO3 solution and dryed over anhydrous MgSO4.



  Filtration and concentration in vacuo provided pure product.



  E-1:
Yield: 85%; ÚH NMR (DMSO-d6, 300 MHz, ppm): 8.91   (s,lH),    8.09 (s, 1H), 7.92 (d, 1H), 7.15-7.26 (m, 4H), 6.98   (t,lH),    6.6 (d, 2H), 4.82 (s, 2H), 2.32 (s, 3H); MS   (FAB):    241.



  E-2:
Yield: 88%; ÚH NMR (MeOH-d4, 300 MHz,   ppm):    7.58 (m, 2H), 7.45
 (t, 2H), 7.32 (d, 2H), 7.27 (t, 1H), 6.88 (d, 2H); MS (FAB): 227.  



  Procedure B
 1. A solution of 4,4=-bipiperidine dihydrochloride (5.0g, 20 mmol) in 20 mL of deionized water was brought to pH 8-9 with 5 N NaOH. After the solution was diluted with 240 mL of Ethanol and stirred at RT, Di-t-butyl dicarbonate in 160 mL of Ethanol was added in one portion. The resulting solution was maintained at pH 8-9 with periodic additions of 5 N NaOH. After 3 hrs at
RT, the reaction solution was acidified using 1 N   HC1.    After washing with EtOAc (2 x 100   mL),    the aqueous solution was brought to pH 7 and then washed with EtOAc to extract the mono
Boc product. The organic layer was washed with sat.aq. NaHCO3 (2
X 100mL), sat.aq. NaC1 (2 X 100 mL) and dryed over MgSO4 After concentrating the solution in vacuo,   2.5g    (52% yield) of the mono-Boc secondary amine was obtained.



  B-1:   H    NMR   (MeOW-d4,    300 MHz, ppm): 4.3 (d, 2H), 3.25 (d, 2H), 2.9
 (t, 2H), 2.73 (t, 2H), 1.93 (d, 4H), 1.65 (s,   9X),    1.22-1.56
 (m,6H); MS   (FAB):    268.9; HPLC (Gr A: 5% B to   95    B in 15 mins;
C18 column, 100   A    Buffer B:   0.1W    TFA in Acetonitrile; Buffer A:   0.1t    TFA in HPLC water):   5.67    min.



  Procedure C
 1. To the solution of primary amine (1.0 mmol, obtained from procedure A) or to a solution of the secondary amine (1.0 mmol, obtained from procedure B) in NMP (5 mL), EDC (1.1 mmol) was added and quickly followed by the addition of Bromoacetic acid (1.0 mmol) at RT. After the reaction mixture was stirred at
RT for over 18 hrs, the reaction was partitioned in EtOAc (15 mL) and deionized water (10 mL). The organic phase was washed  with 5% Citric acid (2 X 10 mL), sat. aq. NaHCO3 (2 X 10 mL) and sat. aq. NaCl (10 mL). The organic phase was dried ( MgSO4 ) and concentrated   invacuo    to afford the bromide product:   F-i:   
Yield:   84W;    ÚH NMR (MeOH-d4, 300 MHz, ppm): 7.83 (d, 1H), 7.577.73 (m, 4H), 7.4 (m, 2H), 7.34 (t, 1H), 4.39 (s, 2H), 2.49 (s, 3H); MS   (FAB):    362.



  F-2:
Yield:   898;    ÚH NMR (DMSO-d6, 300 MHz,   ppm):    7.44-7.61 (bm, 6H), 7.41 (t, 2H), 7.02 (t, 1H), 3.25 (s, 2H); MS (FAB) : 348.



  F-3:
Yield: 61%; 1H NMR (CDCl3, 300 MHz, ppm, rotomers): 4.53 (d, 1H), 3.92-4.12 (m, 4H), 3.82 (d, 1H), 3.0 (t, 1H), 2.4-2.7 (m, 3H), 1.55-1.8 (m, 4H), 1.4 (s, 9H), 0.98-1.33 (bm, 6H); MS   (FAB):    382
 (Na+ adduct).



   2. To a solution of an amine (5 mmol) in NMP (4 mL) at 0  C, a solution of the bromide product from step C1 (1.0 mmol) in NMP
 (2 mL) was added dropwise. After the reaction mixture was stirred at 0  C for 30 minutes, the reaction was partitioned in
EtOAc (15 mL) and deionized water (10 mL). The organic phase was washed with   sat.aq.    NaHCO3 (2 X 10 mL), and sat. aq. NaCl (10 mL). The organic phase was dried (MgSO4) and concentrated in vacuo to afford the secondary amine product.



     G-l:   
Yield:   78W;    ÚH NMR (MeOH-d4, 300 MHz, ppm): 7.55-8.0 (bm, 6H), 7.4 (m, 2H), 7.24 (m, 1H), 3.61 (s, 2H), 2.9 (t, 2H), 2.52 (s, 3H), 1.9 (m, 1H), 1.69 (m, 2H), 1.23 (d, 6H); MS   (FAB):    369.



  G-2:  
Yield:   80k;    1H NMR (MeOH-d4, 300 MHz,   ppm):    7.55-7.72 (bm, 6H), 7.49 (t, 2H), 7.21 (t, 1H), 3.59 (s, 2H), 2.84 (t, 2H), 1.89 (m, 1H), 1.64 (q, 2H), 1.12 (d, 6H); MS   (FAB):    355.



  G-3:
Yield:   75t;    1H NMR (MeOH-d4, 300 MHz,   ppm):    7.55-7.72 (bm, 6H), 7.49 (m, 2H), 7.21 (t, 1H), 3.59 (s, 2H), 2.95 (t, 2H), 2.8 (t, 2H), 2.5 (s, 3H), 2.29 (s, 3H), 2.05 (m, 2H); MS   (FAB):    387.



   3. To a solution of the secondary amine (1.0 mmol) from step C2 in NMP (3 mL), EDC (1.1 mmol) was added and quickly followed by the addition of Bromoacetic acid (1.0 mmol) at 00 C.



  After the reaction mixture was stirred for 3 hrs at 00 C, the reaction was partitioned in EtOAc (15 mL) and deionized water
 (10 mL). The organic phase was washed with 5% Citric acid ( 2 X 10 mL), sat.aq. NaHCO3 (2 X 10 mL) and sat.aq. NaCl (10 mL) . The organic phase was dried (MgSO4) and concentrated   invacuo    to afford the N-substituted bromoacetyl product.



  H-1;
Yield:   82W;    1H NMR (DMSO-d6, 300 MHz, ppm) partial NMR of compound: 9.08 (d, 1H), 7.94 (m,2H), 7.43-7.62 (m, 4H), 7.22 (q, 2H), 7.02 (t, 1H), 4.58 (s, 1H), 4.44 (s, 1H), 4.28 (s, 1H), 4.18 (s, 1H), 2.32 (s, 3H), 1.54-1.75 (m, 2H), 1.38-1.53 (m, 1H), 0.98 (m, 6H).



  H-2:
Yield:   72t;    1H NMR (CDCl3, 300 MHz, ppm, rotomers): 4.9 (d, 1H), 3.54-3.82 (bm, 6H), 3.4 (d, 1H), 2.49-2.78 (m, 2H), 2.0-2.3 (m, 3H), 1.02-1.43 (bm, 8H), 0.9 (s, 9H), 0.58-0.88 (bm, 6H), 0.49
 (m, 6H).



  H-3:  
Yield:   50t;    1H NMR (CDCl3, 300 MHz, ppm, rotomers): 4.9 (d, 1H), 3.54-3.82 (bm, 6H), 3.4 (d, 1H), 2.49-2.78 (m, 2H), 2.3-2.52
 (bm, 3H), 2.2 (s, 3H), 1.45-1.72 (m, 4H), 1.3 (s, 9H), 0.8-1.2
 (bm,6H).



  H-4:
Yield:   45k;    1H NMR (CDCl3, 300 MHz, ppm, rotomers): 4.5 (d, 1H), 3.9-4.1 (m, 6H), 3.6 (d, 1H), 2.75-3.0 (bm, 1H), 2.4-2.6 (m, 3H), 1.48-1.71 (bm, 4H), 1.3 (s, 9H), 0.9-1.25 (bm, 6H).



   4.a. To a solution of    -alanine    t-butyl ester hydrochloride
 (5 mmol, SIGMA) in CH2C12 (20 mL) was added triethylamine (5 mmol) at RT After the solution was stirred at RT for 15 mins, the precipitate formed was filtered and the CH2C12 was removed in vacuo to give the free amine,  -alanine t-butyl ester.

 

  4.b. To the $-alanine t-butyl ester (5 mmol) from step 4.a (5 mmol) in NMP (10 mL) at   OC    C, was added dropwise a solution of the N-substituted bromoacetyl product from step C3 in NMP (2 mL). After the reaction mixture was stirred for over 18 hrs at 00
C, the reaction was partitioned in EtOAc (15 mL) and deionized water (10 mL). The organic phase was washed with sat.aq. NaHCO3
 (2 X 10 mL)and sat.aq. NaCl (10 mL). The organic phase was dried
 (MgSO4) and concentrated   invacuo    to afford the secondary amine product.



     1-1:   
Yield:   75k; </RT 
Yield:   45W;    1H NMR (CDCl3, 300 MHz, ppm, rotomers) : 4.6 (d, 1H), 3.9-4.2 (m, 6H), 3.63-3.9 (m, 1H), 3.25 (m,lH), 2.89-3.04 (m, 2H), 2.4-2.7 (m, 5H), 1.0-1.85 (bm, 28H); MS   (FAB):    511.4.



  I-3:
Yield:   508;    1H NMR (CDCl3, 300 MHz, ppm, rotomers) : 4.55 (d, 1H), 4.0-4.3 (m, 4H), 3.5-3.85 (m, 4H), 2.85-3.18 (m, 5H), 2.48-2.71
 (m, 5H), 1.0-1.85 (bm, 28H); MS (FAB): 525.4.



  I-4:
Yield:   60k;    ÚH NMR (CDC13, 300 MHz, ppm, rotomers) : 3.75-4.62 (m, 8H), 3.25 (m, 1H), 2.9 (m, 2H), 2.49-2.75 (m, 5H), 1.0-1.85 (bm, 32H), 0.9 (m, 6H); MS   (FAB):    581.5.



  Procedure D
 1.To a stirred solution of Boc-L-Proline or Boc-Lsubstituted Proline (10 mmol) and EDC (11 mmol) in NMP (10 mL) at RT, was added amine E-1 (10 mmol) obtained from procedure A.



  After the solution was stirred for over 18 hrs, the reaction was partitioned in EtOAc (100 mL) and deionized water (60 mL). The organic phase was washed with 5% Citric acid (2 X 60 mL), sat.aq. NaHCO3, and sat.aq. NaCl (50 mL). The organic phase was dried ( MgSO4) and concentrated in vacuo to afford the coupled product.



  Precursor to J-1:
Yield:   70k;    1H NMR (MeOH-d4, 300 MHz,   ppm):    7.82 (d, 1H), 7.567.77 (m, 4H), 7.4 (m, 2H), 7.22 (t, 1H), 4.4-4.6 (m, 1H), 3.63.85 (m, 2H), 2.5 (s, 3H), 2.0-2.33 (m, 4H), 1.5-1.75 (bd, 9H);
MS (FAB): 439.2.  



   2. To the product of step D1, a solution of 75% TFA in
CH2C12 (25 mL) was added slowly at 0  C. After the mixture was stirred at 0  C for approximately 2 hrs, the reaction was concentrated   invacuo.    The product was redissolved in   CH2C12    concentrated two more times and placed under high vacuum to remove final traces of TFA. Then, the solid residue was triturated in ether for over 18 hrs, filtered and air-dryed.



  (quantitative yield).



     J-l:   
Yield: 80%; 1H NMR   (MeOH-d4,    300 MHz,   ppm):    7.82 (d, 1H), 7.6-7.8 (m, 4H),   7.82-7.93    (q, 2H), 7.74 (t, 1H), 4.58 (m, 1H), -3.6 (m, 2H), 2.62 (m, 1H), 2.5 (s, 3H), 2.32 (m, 3H); MS   (FAB):    339.5.



  J-2:
Yield:   75t;    ÚH NMR (MeOH-d4, 300 MHz,   ppm):    7.82 (d, 1H), 7.6-7.8 (m, 4H), 7.82-7.93 (q, 2H), 7.74 (t, 1H), 4.58-4.76 (m, 3H), 3.75 (m, 2H), 2.5 (s, 3H); MS (FAB) : 358.4 (Na+ adduct)
EXAMPLE 1
AY50
 A. The method described in procedure C was followed, using amines E-l (obtained by using o-Toluidine in procedure A) in step   C1    and Isoamylamine in step C2, to obtain the amine product
 (I-1) in step C4.



   B. A stirred solution of the amine prepared in Example 1A
 (0.9102 mmol, 0.504 g) was treated first with DIEA (0.9102 mmol, 158.6 :1) in 20 mL of NMP at 00 C (under a nitrogen atmosphere), and then Benzoyl choride (0.9102 mmol, 105.7 :1) was added dropwise. After the solution was stirred for 4 hrs, the reaction was partitioned in EtOAc (50 mL) and deionized water (40 mL).  



  The organic phase was washed with 5% Citric acid (2 X 25 mL), sat.aq.NaHCO3 (2 X 25 mL), and sat.aq. NaCl (25 mL). The organic phase was dried (MgSO4) and concentrated in vacuo to afford the desired compound (350 mg, 59%) as a foam: ÚH NMR (CDC13, 300 MHz,   ppm):    6.72-7.55 (brm, 12H), 6.3-6.7 (brd, 1H), 3.8-4.2 (m, 4H), 3.55-3.7 (m, 2H), 3.1-3.5 (brm, 2H), 2.45
 (t, 1H), 2.1 (m, 3H), 0.6-1.6 (brm,   19H) ;    MS (FAB) : 658.5.



   C. To the product from Example 1B (350 mg, 0.5315 mmol), a solution of 25% TFA in CH2Cl2 (5 mL) was added slowly at 00 C.



  After stirring at   0     C for 1 hr, the reaction was concentrated in vacuo. The product was redissolved in   CH2C12,    concentrated two more times and placed under high vacuum to remove final traces of TFA. The product was purified by HPLC to give AY50 (260 mg,   91W)    as a lyophilized powder: ÚH NMR (DMSO-d6, 300 MHz,   ppm):    9.7-10.32 (m, 1H), 9.05 (s, 1H), 7.99 (m, 2H), 7.35-7.77 (m, 7H), 7.25 (q, 2H), 7.05 (t,   1H),    4.0-4.55 (brm, 4H), 3.68 (q, 1H), 3.2 (m, 1H), 2.72 (m, 1H), 2.3
 (s, 3H), 1.3-1.75 (brm, 4H), 0.77-1.22 (brm, 6H); MS (FAB): 602.5; HPLC (Gr A): 8.72 min.



  EXAMPLE 2
AY49
 A. The procedure, as described in Example 1B, was performed utilizing the amine   (1-1,    0.9102 mmol, 0.504 g) prepared by the procedure described in Example 1A, DIEA (0.9102 mmol, 158.5 :1) and m-Anisoyl Chloride (0.9102 mmol, 127.9 ul) to afford the desired product (380 mg, 61% yield) as a foam:   ÚH NMR (DMSO-d6, 300 MHz,   ppm):    9.1 (s, 1H), 7.95 (m, 2H), 7.37.65 (m, 5H), 7.23 (m, 2H), 6.83-7.15 (brm, 4H),   4.0-4.5    (brm, 4H), 3.8-3.91 (m, 3H), 3.15-3.22 (m, 4H), 2.5-2.8 ( m, 2H), 2.35
 (s, 3H), 1.35-1.8 (m, 12H), 0.77-1.22 (brm, 6H); MS   (FAB):    710.2 (Na+ adduct).



   B. The procedure, as described in Example 1C, was performed utilizing the compound from step B (380 mg, 0.5523 mmol) and 25%
TFA in CH2C12 (10 mL) to afford AY49 (315.0 mg, 91%) as a lyophilized powder: 1H NMR   (DMSO-d6,    300 MHz,   ppm):    9.1   (5,    1H), 7.95 (m, 2H), 7.37.65 (m, 5H), 7.23 (m, 2H), 6.83-7.15 (brm, 3H),   4.0-4.5    (brm, 4H), 3.8-3.91 (m, 3H), 3.15-3.22 (m, 4H), 2.5-2.8 (m, 2H), 2.35
 (s, 3H), 1.35-1.8 (m, 3H), 0.77-1.22 (brm, 6H); MS   (FAB):    632.3,   654.2 (Na+ adduct); WPLC (Gr A): 9.05 min.   



  EXAMPLE 3
AY62
 A. To a solution of 2,3-dimethoxybenzoic acid (10.9781 mmol, 2.0 g) in CH2C12 (20 mL) with a drop of DMF, was added oxalyl chloride (10.9781 mmol, 957.702 :1) dropwise at RT After 2 hrs the reaction mixture was concentrated   invacuo    to afford 2,3-dimethoxybenzoyl chloride (1.9 g, 90%): ÚH NMR (CDCl3, 300 MHz,   ppm):    7.52 (m, 1H), 7.12 (d, 2H), 3.89
 (s, 3H), 3.88 (s, 3H).



   B. The procedure as described in Example 1B was performed utilizing the amine (I-1, 2.0031 mmol, 1.073 g) prepared by the procedure described in Example 1A, DIEA (2.2034 mmol, 383.81 :1) and 2,3-dimethoxybenzoyl chloride (2.2034 mmol, 440.677 mg)  prepared in Example 3A to afford the desired product (856.0 mg,   51k    yield) as a foam: 1H NMR (DMSO-d6, 300 MHz, ppm) partial NMR of compound: 9.1 (s, 1H), 7.9-8.1 (m, 2H), 7.4-7.65 (m, 3H), 6.95-7.3 (brm, 4H), 6.66.9 (brm, 1H), 3.7-4.7 (brm, 10H), 2.38 (s, 3H), 1.2- 1.8 (brm, 12H), 0.9-1.1 (m, 5H), 0.8 (d,   2W);    MS (FAB) : 740.4 (Na+ adduct)
 C.

   The procedure as described in Example 1C was performed utilizing the compound from step B (856.0 mg, 1.1922 mmol) and 25% TFA in CH2C12 to afford AY62 (786.0 mg, 98%) as a lyophilized powder:   H    NMR (DMSO-d6, 300 MHz, ppm) partial NMR of compound: 9.1 (s, 1H), 7.9-8.1 (m, 2H), 7.4-7.65 (m, 3H), 6.95-7.3 (brm, 4H), 6.66.9 (brm, 1H), 3.7-4.7 (brm, 10H), 2.38 (s, 3H), 1.2-1.8 (brm,   1H),    1.18 (t,   3H),    0.89-1.1 (m,   4H),    0.8 (d,   2H);    MS (FAB): 662.2, 684.2 (Na+ adduct; HPLC (Gr A): 8.795 min.



  EXAMPLE 4   CX13   
 A. The amine (G-1, 0.271 mmol, 100.0 mg), obtained from step C2 in procedure C using the amines E-1 (obtained by using o-Toluidine in procedure A) in step   C1    and Isoamylamine in C2, was added to a stirred solution of Mono-methyl adipate (0.271 mmol, 40.15 :1) and EDC (0.271 mmol, 51.951 mg) in 4 mL NMP at
RT. After the reaction was stirred for over 18 hrs at RT, the reaction was partitioned in EtOAc (15 mL) and deionized water
 (10 mL). The organic phase was washed with 5% Citric acid (2 X
 10   mL),sat.aq.NaWCO3    (2 X 10 mL), and sat.aq. NaCl (10 mL).

   The  organic phase was dried (MgSO4) and concentrated in vacuo to afford the desired compound (103 mg, 75% ) as a foam: ÚH NMR (CDCl3, 300 MHz, ppm, rotomers) : 8.88 (s, 1H), 7.55 (d, 2H), 6.6-7.4 (brm, 7H), 4.0 (m, 2H), 3.62 (s, 3H), 3.43 (m, 1H), 1.9-2.4 (brm, 7H), 1.29-1.8 (brm, 8H), 0.9 (d,   6H);    MS (FAB) 511.3.



   B. A stirred solution of the compound from step A (103 mg, 0.2034 mmol) in methanol (2 mL) was treated with aq. LiOH (1.0
M, 1.0 mL, 1.0 mmol) at RT for 3 hrs. The reaction was acidified with 1 N HCl and concentrated in vacua. The crude product was purified by HPLC to afford   CX13    (66.0 mg, 65%) as a lyophilized powder: ÚH NMR (DMSO-d6, 300 MHz, ppm): 9.9-10.1 (brd,   1H),    9.05 (d, 1H), 7.95 (m, 2H), 7.55 (m,   4H),    7.25 (q,   2H),    7.05 (t, 1H), 4.1-4.25
 (brd, 1H), 3.5 ( m, 1H), 2.21-2.52 (m, 7H), 1.38-1.71 (m, 7H), 1.2 (t, 1H), 0.95 (m, 6H); MS   (FAB):    497.2; HPLC (Gr A): 8.24 min.



  EXAMPLE 5
P1
 A. The method described in procedure C was followed, using amines E-1 (obtained by using 4,4'-Bipiperidine dihydrochloride in procedure B) in step   C1    and Ammonia in step C2, to afford the amine product (1-2) in step C4.



   B. To a stirred solution of benzoic acid (0.1351 mmol, 16.5 mg) and EDC (0.1351 mmol, 25.902 mg) in 3 mL of NMP, was added the amine (1-2, 0.1351 mmol, 69.0 mg) prepared by the procedure  described in Example 5A. After the solution was stirred for over 18 hrs, the reaction was partitioned in EtOAc (10 mL) and deionized water (5   mL).The    organic phase was washed with 5%
Citric acid (2 X 5 mL), sat.aq. NaHCO3 (2 X 5 mL), and sat.aq.



  NaC1 (5 mL). The organic phase was dryed (MgSO4) and concentrated in vacuo to afford the desired product (35.0 mg, 51%) as a foam.



  C. The procedure as described in Example 1C was performed utilizing the compound from step B (35.0 mg, 0.068 mmol) and 25%
TFA in CH2Cl2 to obtain   P1    (17.0 mg,   55W)    as a lyophilized powder: ÚH NMR (DMSO-d6, 300 MHz, ppm) partial NMR of compound: 8.4 (m, lH), 7.9-8.25 (m, 2H), 7.4 (d,   3H),    4.4 (d, 1H), 3.7-4.2 (m, 5H), 2.18-3.12 (m, 4H), 1.6-1.85 (d, 4H), 0.85-1.41 (m,   6H);    MS
   (FAB):    458.8; HPLC (Gr A): 4.1 min.



  EXAMPLE 6
P2
 A. The method described in procedure C was followed, using amines E-1 (obtained by using 4,4'-bipiperidine dihydrochloride in procedure B) in step   C1    and Methylamine in step C2, to obtain the amine product   (I-3)    in step C4.



   B. The procedure as described in Example   5B    was performed utilizing the amine   (I-3,    0.2835 mmol, 148.8 mg) prepared by procedure described in Example 6A, Benzoic acid (0.2836 mmol, 34.63 mg) and EDC (0.2836 mmol, 54.37   mg)    to afford the desired product (84.0 mg, 56% yield) as a foam.  



   C. The procedure as described in Example 1C was performed utilizing the compound from step B (84.0 mg, 0.158 mmol) and 25%
TFA in CH2Cl2 to obtain P2 (49.0 mg, 66%) as a lyophilized powder.



     H    NMR (DMSO-d6, 300 MHz, ppm) partial NMR of compound: 8.5 (m,   1H),    8.2 (m, 1H), 7.35-7.6 (m, 4H), 4.1-4.6 (m, 6H), 3.8-4.1 (m, 3H), 2.77-3.2 (m, 7H), 1.7-2.0 (m, 4H), 1.0-1.6 (m, 6H); MS
   (FAB) :    473.2; HPLC (Gr A): 4.403 min.



  EXAMPLE 7
 A. The method described in procedure C was followed, using amines E-1 (obtained by using 4,4'-bipiperidine dihydrochloride in procedure B) in step   C1    and Isoamylamine in step C2, to afford the amine product (1-4) in step C4.



   B. The procedure as described in Example   5B    was performed utilizing the amine (1-4, 0.05131 mmol, 29.8 mg) prepared by procedure described in Example 7A, Benzoic acid (0.05131 mmol, 6.2657 mg) and EDC (0.05131 mmol, 9.836 mg) to afford the desired product (15.0 mg,   51k    yield) as a foam.



   C. The procedure as described in Example 1C was performed utilizing the compound from step B (15.0 mg,0.0256 mmol) and   25   
TFA in CH2Cl2 to obtain P3 (9.0 mg, 67%) as a lyophilized powder: 1H NMR   (DMSO-d6,    300 MHz, ppm) partial NMR of compound: 8.5 (m, 1H), 8.2 (m, 1H), 7.33-7.6 (m, 4H), 3.85-4.6 (brm, 6H), 2.8-3.2
 (m, 4H), 0.78-2.0 (brm, 19H); MS (FAB): 529.4, 551.3 (Na+ adduct); HPLC (Gr A): 6.27 min.  



  EXAMPLE 8
CY14
 A. To a stirred solution of Mono-methyl adipate (0.2955 mmol, 43.78 :1) and EDC (0.2955 mmol, 56.65 mg) in 4 mL NMP at
RT, was added the free amine product (J-1, 0.2955 mmol, 100.0 mg), obtained from procedure D using Boc-L-Proline. After the solution was stirred for over 18 hrs, the reaction was partitioned in EtOAc (15 mL) and deionized water. The organic phase was washed with   5    Citric acid (2 X 10 mL), sat.aq. NaHCO3
 (2 X 10 mL), and sat.aq. NaC1 (10 mL).

   The organic phase was dried (MgSO4) and concentrated in vacuo to afford the desired product (88.2 mg, 62%) as a foam: 1H NMR (CDCl3, 300 MHz, ppm): 7.1-7.52 (brm, 8H), 6.1-6.42 (s, 1H), 4.75 (d, 1H), 3.42-3.68 (m, 5H), 1.94-2.42 (brm, 10H), 1.61.8 (m, 4H); MS   (FAB):    481.4, 503.3 (Na+ adduct)
 B.The same procedure as described in Example 4B was performed utilizing the compound from step A (88.2 mg, 0.1832 mmol) and aq.   LiOW    (1.0 M, 1.0 mL, 1.0 mmol) in MeOH (2 mL) to obtain   CY14    (50.8 mg, 60%) as a lyophilized powder:   H    NMR (DMSO-d6, 300 MHz, ppm): 9.9-10.12 (brd, 1H), 9.05 (d, 1H), 7.95 (m, 2H), 7.45-7.61 (m, 4H), 7.24 (q, 2H), 7.05 (t, 1H), 4.45-4.61 (m, 1H), 3.52-3.74 (m, 2H),   1.88-2.44    (brm,   11H),   
 1.6 (m, 4H);

   MS (FAB) : 467.2, 489.2 (Na+ adduct); HPLC (Gr A)
 6.66 min.  



  EXAMPLE 9   CY17   
 A. To a solution of tert-butyl diethyl phosphonoacetate (3.0 mmol, 756.75   mg)    in 25 mL anhydrous THF, stirred at -75   OC    (dry ice / acetone) under a nitrogen atmosphere, was added nbutyl Lithium (3.0 mmol, 1.875 mL) dropwise over a period of 5 mins. After the solution stirred for 1 hr at O    C,    ethyl levulinate (2.7 mmol, 425.7 :1) was added under N2 at O   OC    The reaction was gradually warmed up to RT and stirred for 3.5 h.



  After 3.5 h the reaction mixture was washed with sat.aq. NH4C1 (3 X 100 mL) and concentrated in vacua. Then, 100 mL of ether was added to the residue and the ether layer was washed with deionized water (60 mL), and sat.aq. NaCl (2 X 60 mL). The organic layer was dryed (MgSO4) and concentrated in vacuo to afford the crude product. The crude was purified by flash chromatography using 20:1 hexane:EtOAc to afford the orthogonally protected t-Butyl-6-Carboethoxy-3-Methyl-3
Pentenoate (404.0 mg, 54%) as a viscous liquid:   H    NMR (CDCl3, 300 MHz, ppm, isomers): 5.6 (s, 1H), 4.12 (q, 2H), 2.84 (t,   1H),    2.4-2.53 (m, 4H), 2.1 (s, 2H), 1.47   (s,    9H), 1.23
 (t, 3H); MS (FAB): 264.6 (Na+ adduct); HPLC (Gr A): 12.24 min and   12.48    min.



   B. The product from Example 9A (0.8277 mmol, 200.3 mg) in 10 mL EtOAc was reduced using 5 mole   k    of   10k    Pd/C (0.04139 mmol, 43.63 mg) in a pressurized hydrogenation container. After 1 hr the reaction mixture was centrifuged for 30 mins. The centrifugation with EtOAc (2 X 30 mL) was repeated for a further  30 mins. All the organic layers were pooled and concentrated in vacuo to afford t-Butyl-6-Carboethoxy-3-Methyl-3-Pentanoate (150.0 mg,   75%):    ÚH NMR (CDCl3, 300 MHz,   ppm):    4.1 (q, 2H),   2.18-2.4    (m, 3H), 1.88-2.1 (m, 2H), 1.45-1.75 (m, 3H), 1.44 (s,   9H),    1.23 (t, 3H), 0.92 (d, 3H); MS (FAB) : 266.6 (Na+ adduct)
 C.

   The same procedure as described in Example 4B was performed utilizing   t-Butyl-6-Carboethoxy-3-Methyl-3-Pentanoate   
 (150.0 mg, 0.6147 mmol) and aq. LiOH (1.0 M, 1.0 mL, 1.0 mmol) in MeOH (2 mL) obtained the mono-acid product (100   mg,75%)    as a solid: 1H NMR (CDCl3, 300 MHz,   ppm) :      2.18-2.4    (m, 3H),   1.88-2.1    (m, 2H), 1.45-1.75 (m, 3H), 1.44 (s, 9H), 0.92 (d, 3H); MS   (FAB):    239.1
 (Na+ adduct).



   D. The procedure as described in Example 8A was performed utilizing the acid product from Example 9C (0.0925 mmol, 20.0 mg), the amine (J-1, 0.0925 mmol, 31.30 mg), obtained by using
Boc-L-Proline in procedure D, and EDC (0.0925 mmol, 17.73 mg) in
NMP (3 mL) to afford the desired compound (39.3 mg,   73%):    ÚH NMR (CDCl3, 300 MHz, ppm) partial NMR of compound: 7.1-7.8
 (brm, 8H), 4.75 (m, 1H), 3.43-3.62 (m, 2H), 1.9-2.6 (brm, 12H), 0.8-1.0 (m, 3H); MS   (FAB):    559.3.



   E. The procedure as described in Example 1C was performed utilizing the compound from step D (39.3   mg,0.0703    mmol) and 25%
TFA in CH2C12 to obtain CY17 (20.2 mg, 60%) as a lyophilized powder:  1H NMR (MeOH-d4, 300 MHz,   ppm):    7.81 (d, 1H), 7.52-7.71 (m, 4H), 7.38 (q, 2H), 7.23 (t,   1H),      4.64-4.8    (m, 1H),   3.7-4.0    (m, 2H), 2.05-2.74 (brm, 12H), 1.68-2.0 (m, 2H), 1.05-1.23 (m,   3H);    MS
 (FAB): 481.3, 503.4 (Na+ adduct);   WPLC    (Gr A): 8.1 min.



  EXAMPLE 10
CX12
 A.The procedure as described in Example 8A was performed utilizing the amine (J-2, 0.2974 mmol, 100.0 mg), obtained by using Boc-L-Thioproline in procedure D, adipic acid (0.2974 mmol, 43.46 mg) and EDC (0.3569 mmol, 68.414 mg) in NMP (3 mL) to afford the crude acid product. The crude was purified by HPLC to afford CX12 (30.0 mg,   30k)    as a lyophilized powder: 1H NMR (DMSO-d6, 300 MHz,   ppm):    9.99 (s, 1H), 9.1 (s, 1H), 7.98
 (m, 2H), 7.48-7.62 (m, 4H), 7.25 (q, 2H), 7.05 (t, 1H), 4.555.05 (m, 4H), 3.22 (m, 1H), 2.41 (m, 6H), 1.6 (m, 4H); MS (FAB): 485.5; HPLC (Gr A): 7.935 min.



  EXAMPLE 11
AX41
 A. The method described in procedure C was followed, using amine E-l (obtained by using o-toluidine in procedure A) in step   C1    and Isoamylamine in step C2, to obtain the amine (I-1) in step C4.



   B. To a stirred solution of amine prepared in Example 11A
 (0.072 mmol, 39.8 mg) and DIEA (0.0864 mmol, 15.1 :1) in NMP (4 mL) at 0  C, was added acetic anhydride (0.0792 mmol, 7.5 :1).



  After the solution was stirred for 4 h at   0 C,    the reaction was partitioned in EtOAc (10 mL) and deionized water (5 mL). The  organic phase was washed with 5% citric acid (2 X 5 mL), sat.aq.



  NaHCO3 (2 X 5 mL), and sat.aq. NaCl (5 mL). The organic phase was dryed (MgSO4) and concentrated in vacuo to afford the desired compound (20 mg,   50k)    as a foam.



   C. The procedure described in Example 1C was performed utilizing the compound from step B (20.0 mg, 0.034 mmol) and 25%
TFA in CH2C12 to afford AX41 (9.0 mg, 50%) as a lyophilized powder:
 H NMR (DMSO-d6, 300 MHz, ppm) partial NMR of compound: 9.7610.22 (brm, 1H), 9.05 (d, 1H), 7.95 (m, 2H), 7.45-7.65 (m, 4H), 7.24 (q, 2H), 7.03 (t, 1H), 4.1-4.54 (brm, 4H), 2.33 (s, 3H), 2.18 (s,   1H),    1.98 (d, 2H), 1.3-1.8 (brm, 3H), 0.98 (m,   6H);    MS
   (FAB):    540.3; HPLC (Gr A): 7.047 min.



  EXAMPLE 12   AY48   
 A. The method described in procedure C was followed, using amine E-1 (obtained by using o-Toluidine in procedure A) in step   C1    and Isoamylamine in step C2, to obtain the amine   (1-1)    in step C4.



   B. The procedure as described in Example   5B    was performed utilizing the amine from Example 12A (0.0905 mmol, 50.0 mg),
Mono-methyl succinate (0.0905 mmol, 11.96 mg) and EDC (0.09955 mmol, 19.084 mg) to afford the desired compound (30 mg, 50%) as a foam.



   C. The procedure as described in Example 1C was performed utilizing the compound from step B (30 mg, 0.045 mmol) and 25%
TFA in CH2Cl2 to obtain AY48 (15 mg,   46W)    as a lyophilized powder:   ÚH NMR (DMSO-d6, 300 MHz, ppm) partial NMR of compound: 9.7610.22 (brm, 1H), 9.05 (d, 1H), 7.95 (m, 2H), 7.45-7.65 (m, 4H), 7.24 (q, 2H), 7.03 (t, 1H), 4.1-4.54 (brm, 4H), 3.18   (s,      3H),    2.33 (s, 3H), 1.3-1.8 (brm, 3H), 0.98 (m,   6H) ;    MS   (FAB):    612.4;
HPLC (Gr A): 7.998 min.



  EXAMPLE 13
AY44
 A. The method described in procedure C was followed, using amine E-l (obtained by using o-Toluidine in procedure A) in step   C1    and Isoamylamine in step C2, to obtain the amine (I-1) in step C4.



   B. The procedure as described in Example   5B    was performed utilizing the amine from Example 12A (0.0398 mmol, 22.0 mg), 3methoxy propionic acid (0.0398 mmol, 3.7   p1)    and EDC (0.04378 mmol, 8.393 mg) to afford the desired compound (15 mg, 59%) as a foam.



   C. The procedure as described in Example 1C was performed utilizing the compound from step B (15 mg, 0.0234 mmol) and 25%
TFA in CH2C12 to obtain AY44 ( 10 mg, 74%) as a lyophilized powder: 1H NMR (DMSO-d6, 300 MHz, ppm) partial NMR of compound: 9.05 (d, 1H), 7.95 (m, 2H),   7.45-7.65    (m, 4H), 7.24 (q, 2H), 7.03 (t, 1H), 4.1-4.54 (brm, 4H), 3.29 (m, 3H), 2.33 (s, 3H), 1.3-1.8
 (brm, 3H), 0.98 (m,   6H);    MS (FAB) : 584.3, 607.4 (Na+ adduct)
HPLC (Gr A): 6.17 min.  



  Synthesis of   SX44   
A. To a suspension of 1,4-phenylenediamine (9.15 g, 86 mmol) in dichloromethane (30 mL) was added o-tolyl isocyanate (10.5 mL, 86 mmol). After stirring at room temperature for 30 min the suspension was filtered and washed with dichloromethane (200   mL).    Drying under vacuum afforded the desired product as a gray solid (15.8 g, 65.6 mmol.   76e),       > 99t    purity based on HPLC.



     HNMR      (d6-dmso) :    6 8.61 (1H, s), 7.95   (1H,    d), 7.81 (1H, s), 7.30
 (2H, m), 7.15 (2H, d), 7.0 (1H, t), 6.61 (2H, d), 4.88 (2H, bs), 2.32 (3H, s).



  B. To a solution of (2R)-[(t-Butyloxycarbonyl)methyl]-4-methyl valeric acid (Oxford Asymmetry) (2.4 g, 10.4 mmol) in DMF (20 mL) cooled to   0     C was added HOBT (2.1 g, 15.5 mmol) followed by
EDC (2.4 g, 13.0 mmol) and   Hunigs    base (5.4 mL, 31.1 mmoL).



  After stirring for 15 min 2,3-dimethoxy   9-phenyl    alanine methyl ester hydrochloride (2.9 g, 10.4 mmol) was added. After stirring overnight with warming to room temperature the reaction was worked up by precipitating the product with   60%    aqueous bicarbonate. The product was filtered and washed with water, 5% citric acid and brine. The product was dried under vacuum to afford the desired product (4.5 g, 9.9 mmol,   99%),     > 88 purity based on HPLC as a white powder.



     HNMR      (CDC13):      6    6.81 (3H, m), 6.60 (1H, bd), 5.35 (1H, m), 3.76
 (3H, s), 3.75 (3H, s), 3.63 (3H, s), 2.90-2.50 (4H, m), 2.30
 (1H, - 1.45 (2H, m), 1.40 (9H, s), 1.15 (1H, m), 0.88 (3H, d), 0.82 (3H, s).  



  C. To a solution of the compound from step B (4.5 g, 9.9 mmol) in dichloromethane (15 mL) was added trifluoroacetic acid (5 mL) and the reaction was stirred at room temperature for 3 h. The solvents were removed in vacuo and the product precipitated out by the addition of ether. Filtration of the solid and drying under vacuum afforded the desired compound (2.9 g, 7.3 mmol,   74W)    as a white powder    > 96t    pure based on HPLC.



     HNMR      (CDCl3) :    6 6.92 (1H, bd), 6.70 (3H, m), 5.35 (1H, m), 3.85 (6H,   s),    3.65 (3H, s), 2.95 - 2.40 (5H, m), 1.55 (2H, m), 1.35
 (1H, m), 0.90 (3H, d), 0.87 (3H, d)
D. To a solution of the compound from step C (1.9 g, 4.8 mmol) in DMF (15 mL) was added HBTU (2.1 g, 5.5 mmol) followed by
Hunig=s base (2.1 mL, 12.1 mmol) and the compound from step A
 (1.15 g, 4.8 mmol). After stirring overnight at room temperature the reaction was worked up by precipitation out of 60% aqueous bicarbonate, washed with water, 5% citric acid and brine. Drying under vacuum afforded the desired product (2.9 g, 4.7 mmol,   98t)    as a tan solid  >  87% pure based on HPLC.



     1HNMR      (CDCl3) :      5    9.01 - 6.81 ( 15H, m), 5.35 (1H, m),   3.85(3B,    s), 3.84 (3H, s), 3.65   (3H,    s), 2.90 - 2.35 (5H, m), 2.33 (3H,   s),    1.65-0.90 (3H, m), 0.90 (3H, d). 0.86 (3H, d).



  E. To a solution of the compound from step D (2.9 g, 4.6 mmol) in methanol (30 mL) containing DMF (15 mL) was added 2M LiOH (7 mL, 13.8 mmol) and the reaction was stirred overnight at room temperature. The methanol was removed in vacuo and the crude mixture was added dropwise to a O  C solution of 1M   HC1.    The  precipitate was filtered and washed with water, methanol/ether
 (1:9) and ether. The product was dried under vacuum to afford crude SX44  > 91% pure based on HPLC. Recrystallization from isopropanol affords pure SX44 as a white solid (1.25 g, 2.1 mmol, 46%)    > 98t    pure based on HPLC.



     1HNMR      (d6-dmso) :       &     9.95 (1H, s), 9.11   (1H,    s),   8.61 (1W,    d), 8.01 (1H, s), 7.95 (1H, d), 7.60 (2H, d), 7.47 (2H, d), 7.24
 (2H, m), 7.02 (2H, m), 6.90 (2H, m), 5.25 (1H, m), 3.82 (3H, s), 3.81 (3H, s), 2.98 - 2.60   (3H,    m), 2.46 ( 2H, m), 2.33 (3H, s), 1.65 - 1.10 (3H, m), 0.93 (3H, d). 0.84 (3H, s).



     ESMS(+):    m/z = 605
Synthesis of SY62
A. To a solution of (S)-3-(1-Oxopropyl)-4-(phenylmethyl)-2- oxazolidinone (922 mg, 3.95 mmol) in dry THF (40 mL) cooled to 78   C    was added lithium diisopropylamide (2.4 mL, 4.5 mmol,
Aldrich 2.0 M) dropwise. The reaction was allowed to at -78  C for 1 h resulting in a pale yellow solution. t-Butyl bromoacetate (1.74 mL, 11.8 mmol) was then added at once and the reaction was stirred for an additional 15 min at -78  C then warmed to   0     C and allowed to proceed an additional 45 min. The reaction was quenched with sat. aqueous ammonium chloride and the THF was removed.

   The aqueous layer was extracted with dichloromethane (3 X 50 mL) and the combined organic extracts washed with brine, dried with sodium sulfate and concentrated to afford a thick syrup which when placed in the freezer solidifies to a waxey solid. Trituration with cold hexane affords the  desired product (735 mg, 2.11 mmol, 54%) as a white solid in  > 90% purity by HPLC.

 

     HNMR      (CDC13):    8 7.40 - 7.15 (5H, m), 4.65 (1H, m), 4.25 - 4.0 (3H, m), 3.32 (1 H, dd), 2.83 (1H, dd), 2.76 (1H, dd), 2.37 (1H, dd), 1.41 (9H, s), 1.19 (3H, d).



  B. To a   0    C solution of the compound from step A (350 mg, 1.00 mmol) in THF (15 mL) and water (5 mL) was added 30% hydrogen peroxide (1.10 mL, 10.1 mmol) followed by 2.0 M lithium hydroxide (1.0 mL, 2.0 mmol) and the solution was allowed to stir for 2-3 h until judged complete by   WPLC.    The reaction was quenched with excess sodium sulfite and the pH adjusted to -10 with saturated sodium bicarbonate if neccesary. The THF was removed in vacuo and the aqueous layer wass diluted with water
 (30 mL) and extracted twice with dichloromethane (30 mL). The aqueous layer was then acidifie 0.85 mmol) to afford the desired compound (268 mg, 0.6 mmol,   788)    in  >  85% purity based on HPLC as a white foam.



     HNMR      (CDC13) :      #6.81    (3H, m) , 6.72 (1H, bd), 5.40 (1H, m), 3.85
 (3H, s), 3.84 (3H, s), 3.41 (3H, s), 2.96 - 2.15   (5H,    m), 1.41
 (9H, s), 1.14 (3H, d)
D. Following the procedure for SX44C, the compound from step
C(268 mg, 0.6 mmol was deprotected to afford desired   product(210    mg, 0.59 mmol, 98%) as a thick pale yellow syrup.



  ÚHNMR   (CDC13):      6    6.97 (1H, bd), 5.33 (1H, m), 3.85 (3H, s), 3.84
 (3H, s), 3.58 (3H, s), 2.95 - 2.40 (5H, m), 1.24 (3H, d)
E. Following the procedure for the preparation of SX44D, the compound from step D (210 mg, 0.60 mmol) was coupled to SX44A
 (168 mg, 0.70 mmol) to afford the desired compound (320 mg, 0.55 mmol, 92%) -72% pure based on HPLC as a tan solid.



  ÚHNMR   (d6-dmso):    6 9.92 (1H, s), 9.42   (1H,    br), 8.52 (1H, d), 8.15   (1H,    br), 7.92 (1H, d), 7.61 (2H, d), 7.47 (2H, d), 7.25
 (2H, m), 7.10 - 6.85 (4H, m), 5.35 (1H, m), 3.85 (3H, s), 3.84
 (3H, s), 3.63 (3H, s), 3.15 - 2.40 (5H, m), 2.35 (3H, s), 1.12
 (3H, d).



  F. Following the procedure for the hydrolysis of SX44D, the compound from step E (300 mg, 0.52 mmol) afforded crude SY62
 (108 mg)    > 90k    pure based on HPLC. A small amount was purified by HPLC to afford SY62 (8 mg)    > 99W    pure as a white solid.  



     HNMR      (d6-dmso) :    6 9.95 (1H,   s),    9.04 (1H, s), 8.46 (1H, d), 7.93
 (2H, bm), 7.59 (2H, d), 7.47 (2H, d), 7.24 (2H, m), 7.21 - 6.89
 (4H, m), 5.22 (1H, m), 3.83 (3H, s), 3.8 (3H, s), 2.95 - 2.65
 (5H, m), 2.34 (3H, s), 1.10 (3H, d)
ESMS (-): m/z-H = 561
Synthesis of SY60
A. To a solution of succinic anhydride (200 mg, 2.0 mmol) in dichloromethane (5 mL) was added SX44A (482 mg, 2.0 mmol) and the slurry was stirred overnight at room temperature. The solid was filtered and washed with dichloromethane to afford the desired product (630 mg, 1.8 mmol,   92W)    as a light gray solid.



     1HNMR      (d6-dmso):    6 12.25   (1H,    br), 9.95 (1H, s), 9.05 (1H, s), 7.95 (2H, m), 7.60 (2H, d), 7.50 (2H, d), 7.25 (2H, m), 7.05
 (1H, m), 2.33 (4H, m)
B. To a solution of the compound from step A (192 mg, 0.56 mmol) in DMF (4 mL) was added HBTU (265 mg, 0.70 mmol) followed by Hunig=s base (0.25 mL) and   2,3-dimethoxy-ss-phenyl    alanine methyl ester (154 mg, 0.56 mmol). After stirring overnight at room temperature the product was precipitated out with 60% aqueous bicarbonate, washed with water, 5% citric acid, brine and dried under vacuum to afford the desired product (100 mg, 0.18 mmol,   32t)    as a tan solid    > 85t    pure based on HPLC.



     1HNMR      (d6-dmso) :    6 9.93 (1H, s), 9.10 (1H, s), 8.47 (1H, d), 8.0
 (1H, s), 7.95 (1H, d), 7.60 2H, d), 7.46 (2H, d), 7.25 (2H, m),  7.05 (1H, m), 6.92   ( 2W, m) ,    5.26 (1H, m), 3.85 (3H, s), 3.84 (3H, s), 3.66 (3H, s), 2.85 (2H, m), 2.55 (2H, m), 2.36 (3H, s).



  C. To a solution of the compound from step B (100 mg, 0.18 mmol) in methanol was added 2M LiOH (0.3 mL) and the reaction was stirred at room temperature for 3h. The methanol was removed and the product precipitated out of 1N HCl. The solid was filtered, washed with water, ether/methanol (9:1), and ether. Drying under vacuum affords SY60 (74 mg, 0.13 mmol, 72%) as a light tan solid    > 97t    pure based on HPLC.



     'HNMR    (d6-dmso): 6 9.88 (1H, s), 9.05 (1H, s), 8.41   (lH,    d), 8.47
 (1H, s), 7.90 (1H, d), 7.54 (2H, d), 7.43 (2H, d), 7.20 (2H, m), 6.96 (2H, bm), 6.90 (2H, bm), 5.21 (1H, m), 3.81 (3H, s), 3.80
 (3H, s), 2.71 (2H, m), 2.50 (2H, m), 2.30 (3H,   s).   



  ESMS(-): m/z-l = 547
Synthesis of RX19
A. To N-t-boc-L-Leucine-N-Hydroxy Succinimide Ester (3.28g, 0.01mmol) in DMF   (20ml)    at room temperature was added Tyramine
 (1.37g, 0.01mmol) portionwise over 30 minutes with stirring.



  Following two hours of stirring, the DMF was pumped off under reduced pressure and the residue was taken up in   50ml    of methylene chloride. The organic phase was washed with   5%    citiric acid (2x   15ml),    H2O (15 ml) and brine (15ml) dried over
MgSO4, filtered, and concentrated to provide the desired compound
 (3.32g, 95%) as a white foam.   H1 NMR    (CDCl3, 300 MHz, ppm) 7.96
 (d, 1H,   8Hz),    6.93(d, 2H, 8Hz), 6.73(d, 2H,   8Hz),    6.53(bs, 1H),  5.09(d,   1H,    8Hz), 4.02(bs, 1H), 3.47-3.31 (bm, 2H), 2.64(t, 2H, 7Hz),   1.55(m,    2H),   1.37(s,    9H),   0.84(d,    6H, 6Hz), m/z 351.



  B. A mixture of the compound from step A (1g, 2.85 mmol) and
Bromo-methylacetate (0.45g, 2.85 mmol) in acetone (15 ml) was refluxed with solid K2CO3 for 3.5 hours. The reaction mixture was cooled, filtered, and concentrated to yield the desired product (1.09g, 91%) as an amber gum.   H1 NMR(CDCl3,    300 MHz, ppm), 7.08 (d, 2H, 8Hz), 6.81(d, 2H, 8Hz),   6.14(s,    1H), 4.84 (s, 1H), 4.59(s, 2H), 4.00(s, 1H), 3.78 (s, 3H), 3.78-3.40(bm, 2H), 2.71(t, 2H, 7Hz), 1.60-1.39 (m, 2H), 0.89(s, 9H), 0.87(d, 6H, 6Hz); m/z 423.



  C. To the compound from step B (353 mg, 0.836 mmol) in 1 ml of
CH2C12 cold was added TFA (3 ml) and the mixture was stirred at room temperature for 3 hours. The reaction was concentrated under reduced pressure to provide the desired product which was used without purification.   H1    NMR   CDC13,    300 MHz, ppm) 7.59
   (bs,3H),    7.24 (m,lH), 7.04 (d, 2H, 9 Hz), 6.77 (d, 2H, 9   Hz),4.60    (s, 2H,4.04 (m, 1H), 3.79 (S, 3H), 3.52-3.43 (bm, 2H),2.75-2.70 (t, 2H, 6 Hz), 1.56 (m, 2H), 1.46 (m, 1H), 0.84
 (d, 6H, 6   Hz);    m/z 323.



  D. A mixture of 2-MPUPA (225   mg,      0.79mmol),    HOBt (169mg,   1.25mmol),    and EDC (192mg,   1.OOmmol)    was stirred in DMF (5ml) at room temperature for 1.5 hours. In a separate vial, the compound from step C (0.836 mmol) in DMF   (imi)    cold was neutralized with TEA dropwise (green to litmus) with stirring.



  The two solutions were combined and stirred at room temparature  overnight. The reaction mixture was filtered and the volume reduced by one half under vacuum then dripped into rapidly stirred   5    sodium bicarbonate   (50ml).    Following one hour of stirring the solids were collected by filtration, washed with water, and air dried to give the desired compound (140mg, 35%) as a beige solid. H NMR (DMSO, 300 MHz, ppm) 9.06(s,   1H),    8.20(d, 1H, 8Hz), 8.07(m, 1H), 8.00(s, 1H), 7.94(d, 1H, 8Hz), 7.47(d, 2H, 9Hz), 7.27-7.19(m, 6H), 7.03(t, 1H, 7Hz), 6.92(d, 2H, 9Hz), 4.84(s, 2H), 4.34-4.31(m, 1H), 3.78(s, 2H), 3.48(d, 1H, 6Hz), 3.44(s, 3H), 3.37-3.27(m, 2H), 2.72(t, 2H, 7Hz), 2.33(s, 3H),   1.58-1.46(m,    3H), 0.91(dd, 6H, 6Hz, 13Hz); m/z 589.



  E. A solution of the compound from step D (24mg,   0.041mmol)    and 2N LiOH (62 ul, 0.122mmol)in DMF (lml) was stirred at room temperature for 6 hours. The reaction mixture was acidified (red to litmus) with TFA and purified directly by preparative
HPLC resulting in RXl9 (10 mg, 43%) as a white solid. H1 NMR (DMSO, 300 MHz, ppm) 9.27(s, 1H),   8.18(m,    1H), 8.16(m, 1H), 7.92 (d, 1H, 7Hz), 7.46(d, 2H, 8Hz), 7.19-7.03(m, 12H),   6.88(d,    2H, 8Hz), 4.63(s, 2H), 4.33(m, 1H), 2.69(t, 8Hz), 2.34(s, 3H), 1.511.33(m, 3H), 0.96-0.88(dd, 6H, 6Hz, 12Hz), m/z 5.73.



  Synthesis of RX23
A. To a stirred solution of m-hydroxyaniline   (1.09g,      0.01mmol)    and HOBt (2.0g,   0.015mmol)    in DMF (12ml) at 0 C was added EDC
 (2.7g, 0.014 mmol). The mixture was allowed to warm to room temperature and stirred for 1 hour. Next the reaction was cooled to   0     C and and 2-MPUPA (2.84g, 0.01 mmol) was added.



  Triethylamine was added dropwise until the mixture was basic  
 (green to litmus) and stirring continued overnight at room temperature. Following filtration, the mixture was dripped into   500ml    of vigorously stirring   5    sodium bicarbonate. Following two hours of stirring, the solids were collected by filtration through a coarse sinter glass funnel and washed copiously with
H2O. Overnight drying under vacuum gave the desired product
 (3.2g, 85%) as an off white solid. H NMR (DMSO, 300 MHz, ppm) 7.94(s, 1H), 7.82 (d, 1H   8Hz),    7.21 (d, 2H, 8Hz), 7.20-6.90 (m, 7H), 6.42(d, 1H, 7Hz) 3.53(s, 2H), 2.22(s, 3H); m/z 376.



  B. To a stirred solution of the compound from step A (200mg, 0.53 mmol) and 4-bromo-ethyl butyrate (104   mg,    0.53 mmol) in DMF
 (1 ml) was added K2CO3 (120 mg, 1.45 mmol). The slurry was stirred at 70-75   OC    for 6 hours, filtered through a sinter glass funnel and dripped into   50ml    of vigorously stirring 5% HCl. The aqueous slurry was extracted with 3 x 50 ml of EtoAc.

   The organic phases were combined and washed with brine (25 ml), dried over MgSO4 and concentrated to give the desired compound
 (150 mg, 57%) as a yellow solid. 1H NMR (DMSO, 300 MHz, ppm)
 8.98 (s,   1H)    7.88 (s, 1H), 7.85(d, 1H, 8Hz), 7.40 (d, 2H, 7Hz) 7.3-7.1(m, 6H), 6.95(t, 1H, 6Hz), 6.6(d, 1H, 6Hz) 4.45(t, 1H,
 6Hz), 4.02(q, 2H, 7Hz), 3.91(t, 2H, 7Hz), 3.54(s, 2H), 2.42(t,
 2H, 7Hz), 2.25(s, 3H), 1.94(t, 2H, 7Hz), 1.15(t, 3H, 7Hz); m/z
 490.



   C. To a stirred solution of the compound from step B (150mg,
 0.31 mmol) in DMF (1 ml) at room temperature was added 2N   LiOH   
 (385 ul, 0.77mmol). The mixture was stirred overnight and
 following acidification with TFA (red to litmus) an aliquot was  purified by preparative HPLC to give RX23.   1HNMR    (DMSO, 300 MHz, ppm) 9.01(s, 1H), 7.91(s,   1H)    7.83 (d, 1H, 8Hz), 7.39(d, 1H, 8Hz), 7.29 (s, 1H), 7.23-7.14(m, 5H), 6.92(t, 1H, 8Hz) 6.6(d, 1H, 8Hz), 3.92(t, 2H, 7Hz), 3.54(s, 2H), 2.35(t, 2H, 7Hz), 2.22
 (s, 1H), 1.90(m, 2H); m/z 460.



  Synthesis of RX19
A. As described for the synthesis of RX23B utilizing RX23A (119 mg, 0.317 mmol) and 3-Bromo-propionaldehyde dimethylacetal(89 mg, 0.49 mmol) with 250 mg of K2CO3. The solids were filtered and the DMF was pumped off under high vacuum. Recrystalization from methanol provided the desired product (75mg, 52%) as a white solid.   H1 NMR      (DMSO,    300 MHz, ppm) 8.98(s, 1H), 7.88(s, 1H), 7.83(d, 1H, 8Hz), 7.39(d, 2H, 8Hz), 7.32(s, 1H), 7.32-7.12(m, 6H), 6.93(t, 1H, 6H), 6.6(m, 1H), 4.53(t, 6H), 3.92(t, 2H, 7H), 3.54(s, 2H),   3.33(s,    3H), 3.24(s, 3H), 2.22(s, 3H), 1.95(q, 2H, 6Hz,   6Hz),    m/z (M+Na)+ 500.



  B. The compound from step A (29mg, 0.061 mmol) in 2mL of 50/50
THF/H2O with a catalytic amount of p-toluenesulfonic was stirred at 40  C for 4 hours. The reaction mixture was reduced under vacuum and used without purification: m/z 454. The crude residue was taken up in 2 ml of acetone, cooled to 0/ in an ice bath and 44 uL of Jones reagent was added. The reaction mixture was allowed to warm to room temparature with stirring overnight.



  Isopropanol (2ml) was added and the mixture was stirred an additional 30 minutes, filtered, and concentrated under high vacuum. Preparative HPLC provided RXl9   (15.5mg,      57)    as a tan solid.   H1 NMR    (DMSO, 300 MHz, ppm) 9.01(s,   1H),      7.9(s,    1H),  7.83(d, 1H, 8Hz), 7.40 (d, 2H, 8Hz), 7.31(s, 1H), 7.24-7.09(m, 6H), 6.93(t, 1H, 7Hz), 6.59(d, 1H, 8Hz), 4.09(t, 2H, 6Hz), 3.54(s, 2H), 2.66(t, 2H, 6Hz), 2.22(s, 3H); m/z 448.



  Preparation of BX41
A. To a solution of Na2CO3 (1.33 g, 12.51 mmol) in H2O (35 mL) was added portionwise 2-amino-4-fluorobenzoic acid (1.94 g, 12.51 mmol). The mixture was stirred at RT until homogeneous, then cooled in an ice bath. To the cold solution was gradually added phosgene (9.72 mL of a 1.93M solution in toluene, 18.76 mmol). After completing the addition, the reaction was stirred briskly at RT for 2 h. The precipitated solids were collected by suction filtration, rinsed with H20 (1 x 35 mL, 1 x 20 mL), chased with n-hexane, and dried on the filter. There was obtained 2.023 g (89%) of desired product as a white solid: m.p.



     =    228-229   OC;    TLC (1:1 CH2Cl2/Et2O) Rf = 0.74; 1H NMR (CDCl3, 300
MHz, ppm) 7.97-7.93 (m,   1H),    6.84-6.79 (m, 2H).



  B. Under a stream of dry N2, NaH (0.459 g of a 60% dispersion, 11.48 mmol) was washed with n-hexane (2 x 10 mL), suspended in anhydrous DMF (55 mL), and cooled in an ice bath. To the cold suspension was added dropwise a solution of the product from part A (1.98 g, 10.93 mmol) in anhydrous DMF (55 mL). After completing the addition, the mixture was stirred at   0      OC    for 45 min. To the resulting nearly colorless solution was added MeI
 (0.71 mL, 11.48 mmol). The reaction was stirred at RT for 2 h until judged complete by TLC analysis. The DMF was removed by rotary evaporation under high vacuum. The syrupy residue was dissolved in EtOAc/H2O, separated, and the organic layer washed  with H2O (1x), brine   tax),    and dried (MgSO4).

   Filtration and concentration provided 2.04 g (96%) of the desired product as a pale yellow solid: TLC (100% CH2Cl2) Rf = 0.18; 1H NMR   (CDCl3,    300
MHz, ppm) 8.10-8.04 (m, 1H), 6.95-6.89 (m, 1H), 6.84-6.77 (m, 1H), 3.46 (s, 3H).



  C. A mixture of the product from part B (2.04 g, 10.45 mmol) and glycine (0.79 g, 10.45 mmol) in glacial AcOH (22 mL) was briskly refluxed under N2. After 18 h, the reaction was judged complete by TLC analysis and cooled to RT. Most of the AcOH was removed by rotary evaporation under high vacuum. The syrupy residue was triturated with Et2O (20 mL) and stirred briskly at RT for 2 h.



  The precipitated solids were collected by suction filtration, rinsed with Et2O, and dried on the filter. There was obtained 1.806 g   (83k)    of the desired product as a white solid: MS (ESP+) 208.9; TLC (100% EtOAc) Rf = 0.30; 1H NMR (CDCl3, 300 MHz, ppm) 7.84 (br t, 1H), 7.89-7.74 (m, 1H), 6.92-6.86 (m, 1H), 6.83-6.79 (m, 1H), 3.65 (m, 2H), 3.24   (s,3H).   



  D. In the manner described for the preparation of BX47, part B, the product of part C above (0.50 g, 2.402 mmol), ethyl acrylate (0.39 mL, 3.60 mmol), anhydrous CsF (0.401 g, 2.642 mmol), and tetraethyl orthosilicate (0.54 mL, 2.40 mmol) were reacted in
THF (8 mL) at RT under N2 for 18 h. The crude product was purified by flash chromatography   (100t    CH2Cl2 to   10k      Et2O/CH2C12)    to provide 0.51 g (69%) of pure product as a white solid: MS (ESP+) 309.2; TLC (10%   Et20/CH2Cl2)    Rf = 0.30; 1H NMR   (CDCl3,    300
MHz, ppm) 7.83-7.78 (m, 1H), 6.97-6.90 (m, 1H), 6.86-6.82 (m, 1H), 4.08 (q, 2H, J = 7.15 Hz), 3.98 (B of AB, 1H, J = 14.91  
Hz), 3.87-3.80 (m, 3H), 3.30 (s, 3H), 2.74-2.54 (m, 2H), 1.19 (t, 3H, J = 7.20   Hz).   



  E. In the manner described for the preparation of BX47, part C, the product of part D above (0.51 g, 1.68 mmol) was reacted with fuming nitric acid (3 mL) for 18 h. There was obtained 0.49 g   (83W)    of crude desired product as a foam: MS (ESP+) 354.0; TLC   (100t      Et2O)    Rf = 0.25;   H    NMR   (CDCl3,    300 MHz, ppm) 8.61 (d, 1H, J = 8.34 Hz), 7.07 (d, 1H, J = 11.83 Hz), 4.11 (q, 2H, J = 7.11
Hz), 4.02 (s, 2H), 3.88 (t, 2H, J = 6.63 Hz), 3.38 (s, 3H), 2.80-2.57 (m, 2H), 1.23 (t, 3H, J = 7.21   Hz).   



  F. In the manner described for the preparation of BX47, part D, the product of part E above (0.35 g, 0.991 mmol), Fe powder (0.166 g, 2.97 mmol), and glacial AcOH (0.11 mL, 1.98 mmol) were refluxed in 2:1 EtOH/H2O (10 mL) under N2 for 3 h. There was obtained 0.302 g   (94k)    of crude desired product as an oil: MS (ESP+) 324.0; TLC (100% EtOAc) Rf = 0.53; ÚH NMR   (CDCl3,    300 MHz, ppm) 7.32 (d, 1H, J = 9.41 Hz), 6.85 (d, 1H, J = 11.8 Hz), 4.51 (br s, 1H), 4.15-4.00 (m, 3H), 3.89-3.79 (m, 3H), 3.29 (s, 3H), 2.78-2.60 (m, 2H), 1.26-1.20 (m, 3H).



  G. The product of part F (0.30 g, 0.93 mmol), 4nitrophenylacetic acid (0.169 g, 0.93 mmol) and EDC (0.269 g, 1.40 mmol) were dissolved in anhydrous DMF and stirred at RT under N2. After 18 h, the reaction was judged complete by TLC and the DMF removed by rotary evaporation under high vacuum.



  The residue was dissolved in EtOAc/H2O, separated, and the organic layer washed with H2O (lx) and 5% NaHCO3   (lx).    The  combined aqueous layers were extracted with EtOAc (2x). The pooled organic layers were washed with brine (lx) and dried (MgSO4). Filtration, evaporation and flash chromatography (100%   CHCl3    to 40% THF/CHCl3) provided 0.279 g (61%) of pure desired product as a foam: MS (ESP+) 486.6; TLC (1:1 THF/CHC13) Rf = 0.53; 1H NMR   (CDCl3,    300 MHz, ppm) 8.54 (d, 2H, J = 8.64 Hz), 8.22 (dd, 1H, J = 1.90, 6.82 Hz), 7.52 (d, 2H, J = 8.68 Hz), 6.89 (d, 1H, J = 11.79 Hz), 4.12 (q, 2H, J = 7.13 Hz), 4.01 (A of AB, 1H, J = 14.98 Hz), 3.87 (s, 2H), 3.92-3.77 (m, 3H), 3.31 (s, 3H), 2.79-2.57 (m, 2H), 1.23 (t, 3H, J = 7.13   Hz).   



  H. In the manner of part F above, the product of part G (0.28 g, 0.574 mmol), Fe powder (0.096 g, 1.722 mmol), and glacial
AcOH (66   yL)    were refluxed in 2:1 EtOH/H2O (6 mL) under N2 for 2 h. There was obtained 0.208 g   (78k)    of crude desired product as a foam: MS (ESP+) 457.3; TLC (1:1 THF/CHC13) Rf = 0.38; 1H NMR
 (CDC13, 300 MHz, ppm) 8.54 (d, 1H, J = 8.64 Hz), 7.53 (br s, 1H), 7.07 (d, 2H, J = 8.24 Hz), 6.84 (d, 1H, J = 11.70 Hz), 6.73 (d, 2H, J = 8.06 Hz), 4.14-4.04 (m, 2H), 3.99 (A of AB, 1H, J = 14.92 Hz), 3.88-3.72 (m, 3H), 3.64 (s, 2H), 3.27 (s, 3H), 2.782.58 (m, 2H), 1.25-1.20 (m, 3H).



  I. A solution of the product of part H (0.21 g, 0.456 mmol) and o-tolyl isocyanate (0.11 mL, 0.89 mmol) in EtOAc (4.5 mL) was refluxed under N2 for 2 h until judged complete by TLC analysis.



  The reaction was cooled to RT. The precipitated solids were collected by suction filtration, rinsed with EtOAc and dried on the filter to provide 0.159 g (59%) of pure product as an offwhite solid: MS (ESP+) 590.2; TLC (1:1 THF/CHC13) Rf = 0.50; 1H  
NMR (DMSO-d6, 300 MHz, ppm) 10.07 (s, 1H), 8.99 (s, 1H), 8.22 (d, 1H, J = 8.77 Hz) 7.89 (s, 1H), 7.83 (d, 1H, J = 7.96 Hz), 7.427.38 (m, 3H), 7.23 (d, 2H, J = 8.46 Hz), 7.17-7.10 (m, 2H), 6.92
 (t, 1H, J = 7.33 Hz), 4.08-3.98 (m, 3H), 3.84-3.76 (m,   2H),    3.70-3.60 (m, 1H), 3.66 (s, 2H), 3.25 (s, 3H), 2.60-2.54 (m, 2H), 2.23 (s, 3H), 1.14 t, (3H, J = 7.11   Hz).   



  J. To a gently ref fluxing suspension of the product of part I
 (0.100 g, 0.170 mmol) in anhydrous THF (17 mL) under N2 was added sodium trimethylsilanolate (0.68 mL of a   1.OM    solution in   CH2Cl2,    0.678 mmol). The heat was withdrawn and the reaction stirred overnight at RT. The precipitated solids were collected by suction filtration, rinsed with   TWF,    and dried on the filter.



  The crude product was dissolved in glacial AcOH (1 mL), treated with Et2O (1 mL), and stirred briskly overnight. The resulting solids were collected, rinsed with 1:1 Et2O/AcOH, and dried on the filter. There was obtained 0.059 g   (62g)    of BX41 as an offwhite solid: MS (ESP+) 584.0 (M + Na); 1H NMR (DMSO-d6, 300 MHz, ppm) 10.07 (s, 1H), 9.03 (s, 1H), 8.22 (d, 1H, J = 8.71 Hz), 7.93 (s, 1H), 7.82 (d, 1H, J = 7.91   Hz),    7.42-7.38 (m, 3H), 7.24
 (d, 2H, J = 8.36 Hz), 7.17-7.10 (m, 2H), 6.92 (t, 1H, J = 7.32
Hz), 4.05 (A of AB, 1H, J = 15.1 Hz), 3.83 (B of AB, 1H, J = 15.1 Hz), 3.72-3.66 (m, 4H), 3.25 (s, 3H), 2.50-2.46 (m, 2H), 2.23 (s, 3H).



  Preparation of BX67
A. In the manner described for the preparation of   BX41,    part D,   l-methyl-l,4-benzodiazepin-2,5-dione    (5.00 g, 26.29 mmol),  anhydrous CsF (4.393 g, 28.92 mmol), ethyl crotonate (4.90 mL, 39.44 mL) and tetraethyl orthosilicate (5.86 mL, 26.29 mmol) were reacted in anhydrous   TWF    (88 mL) at RT under N2 for 72 h.



  The crude product was purified by flash chromatography (100%
CH2Cl2 to 25% Et2O/CH2C12) to provide 4.04 g (50%) of pure desired product as a white solid: MS (ESP+) 305.4; m.p. = 84-86   OC;    TLC
 (1:1   Et2O/CH2Cl2)    Rf = 0.51; 1H NMR   (CDCl3,    300 MHz, ppm, rotamers) 7.87-7.79 (m, 1H), 7.51-7.45 (m,   1H),    7.28-7.23 (m, 1H), 7.17-7.14 (m, 1H), 5.31-5.22 and 5.19-5.08 (m, 1H), 4.134.03 (m, 2H), 3.86-3.73 (m, 2H), 3.35 (s, 3H), 2.85-2.77 and 2.59-2.45 (m, 2H), 1.33 and 1.28 (d, 3H, J = 6.9 Hz), 1.24-1.16
 (m, 3H).



  *B. In the manner described for the preparation of BX47, part E, the product of part A above (4.04 g, 13.27 mmol) was reacted with fuming nitric acid (26 mL) for 2 h. Trituration of the crude product with Et2O (45 mL) at -20  C gave a solid mass which was broken up with a spatula. The suspension was then stirred briskly at RT for 18 h. The solid was collected by suction filtration, washed with Et2O and dried on the filter.

   There was obtained 4.061 g   (88 )    of pure product as a faintly yellow powder: MS (ESP+) 350.3; m.p. = 104-106   OC;    TLC   (100k    EtOAc) Rf = 0.76; H NMR (CDCl3, 300 MHz, ppm, rotamers) 8.75-8.70 (m, 1H),   8.34-8.29    (m, 1H),   7.33-7.30    (m, 1H),   5.24-5.06    (m, 1H), 4.154.03 (m, 2H), 3.94-3.78 (m, 2H), 3.41 (s, 3H), 2.85-2.76 and 2.63-2.47 (m, 2H), 1.35 and 1.30 (d, 3H, J = 6.9 Hz), 1.27-1.17
 (m,   3H) .     



  C. A suspension of the product of part B (4.06 g, 11.62 mmol),
Fe powder (1.95 g, 34.87 mmol), and glacial AcOH (1.33 mL, 23.24 mmol) in 2:1 EtOH/H20 (120 mL) was refluxed under N2 for 3 h.



  The completed reaction was cooled to RT, diluted with H20 (40 mL) and filtered through Celite. The reaction flask and filter cake were washed with EtOAc (4 x 100 mL). In a separatory funnel, the combined filtrate was washed with 5% NaHCO3 (2 x 100   mL).   



  The combined aqueous washes were extracted with EtOAc (1 x 100 mL), and the pooled organics washed with brine (1 x 100 mL) and dried (MgSO4). Filtration and concentration provided crude product as a foam. This was purified by trituration with   Et2O,    initially at -20  C then at reflux for 2 h. After cooling to
RT, the solids were collected by suction filtration, rinsed with   Et2O,    and dried on the filter. There was obtained   3.09    g (83%) of pure product as a peach-colored solid: MS (ESP+) 320.0; m.p.



     =    116-118   OC;    TLC   (100t    EtOAc) Rf = 0.35; 1H NMR   (CDC13,    300 MHz, ppm, rotamers)   7.15-7.08    (m, 1H),   6.96-6.93    (m, 1H),   6.84-6.79    (m, 1H), 5.27-5.05 (m, 1H), 4.27 (br s, 2H), 4.11-4.01 (m, 2H), 3.84-3.62 (m, 2H), 3.26 (s, 3H), 2.81-2.73 and 2.56-2.42 (m, 2H),   1.30-1.24    (d, 3H, J = 6.9 Hz),   1.22-1.14    (m,   3H).   



  D. In the manner described for the preparation of   BX41,    part G, the product of part C (3.09 g, 9.66 mmol) was condensed with 4nitrophenylacetic acid (2.10 g, 11.59 mmol) in the presence of
EDC (2.78 g, 14.49 mmol) in anhydrous DMF (50 mL) at RT under N2 for 18 h. Crude product was purified by trituration with Et2O at
RT. The solid was collected by suction filtration, washed with
Et2O (100 mL), and dried on the filter.

   There was obtained 4.30 g (92%) of desired product as a pale yellow powder: MS (ESP+)  483.3; m.p. = 118-120   OC;    TLC   (100    EtOAc) Rf = 0.45; 1H NMR   (CDCl3,    300 MHz, ppm, rotamers) 8.77 and 8.32 (s, 1H), 8.25 (dd, 1H, J = 2.54, 8.99 Hz), 8.19 and 8.17 (d, 2H, J = 8.67 and 8.64
Hz, respectively), 7.69 and 7.59 (d, 1H, J = 2.60 and 2.56 Hz, respectively), 7.50 and 7.49 (d, 2H, J = 8.73 and 8.68 Hz, respectively), 7.15 (d, 1H, J = 8.98 Hz), 5.28-5.13 (m, 1H), 4.09 and 3.98 (q, 2H, J = 7.12 and 7.13 Hz, respectively), 3.873.73 (m, 4H), 3.35 and 3.32 (s, 3H), 2.84-2.75 and 2.54-2.47 (m, 2H), 1.32 and 1.25 (d, 3H, 6.93 and 6.86 Hz, respectively), 1.21 and 1.15 (t, 3H, J = 7.23 and 7.12 Hz, respectively).



  E. In the manner described in part C above, the product of part
D (4.30 g, 8.91 mmol) was reduced with Fe powder (1.49 g, 26.74 mmol) and AcOH (1.02 mL, 17.82 mmol) in refluxing 2:1 EtOH/H20
 (90 mL). After an aqueous work-up, there was obtained 3.98 g
 (99%) of crude product as a brittle foam: MS (ESP+) 453.5; TLC
   (100    EtOAc) Rf = 0.30;   H    NMR (CDC13, 300 MHz, ppm, rotamers) 8.09 (m, 1H), 7.43-7.38 (m, 1H), 7.10-7.02 (m, 3H), 6.73-6.69
 (m, 2H),   5.21-5.08    (m, 1H), 4.13-4.01 (m, 2H), 3.76 (s, 2H), 3.60 (s, 2H), 3.31 and 3.30 (s, 3H), 2.82-2.74 and 2.53-2.46(m, 2H), 1.34-1.15 (m, 6H).



  F. In the manner described for the preparation of BX41, part I, the product of part E (3.98 g, 8.8 mmol) was refluxed in EtOAc 90 mL) with o-tolyl isocyanate (2.18 mL, 17.6 mmol) for 3 h.



  The reaction was cooled to RT and concentrated to roughly onethird of the original volume. The precipitated solids were collected by suction filtration, rinsed with EtOAc (1 x 25 mL) and dried on the filter. There was obtained 3.77 g   (73k)    of  desired product as an off-white powder: MS (ESP+) 586.4; m.p. = 164-166   OC;    TLC (1:1 THF/CHC13) Rf = 0.45; ÚH NMR (CDCl3, 300 MHz, ppm, rotamers) 9.02 and 8.90 (br s,   1H),    7.96 and 7.92 (br s, 1H), 7.88-7.84 (m, 1H), 7.68-7.63 (m,   1H),    7.51-7.48 (m, 1H), 7.31 (br s, 1H), 7.03-6.85 (m, 8H), 5.22-5.10 (m, 1H), 4.06-3.92 (m, 2H), 3.75-3.65   (m,    2H), 3.40 (s, 2H), 3.26 and 3.23 (s, 3H), 2.79-2.70 and 2.51-2.44 (m, 2H), 2.06 (s, 3H), 1.30 and 1.22 (d, 3H, J = 6.9 Hz), 1.17-1.11 (m, 3H).

 

  G. To a cloudy solution of the product of part F (1.00 g, 1.71 mmol) in CH2C12 (7 mL) was gradually added at RT sodium trimethylsilanolate (10.25 mL of a   l.0M    solution in CH2Cl2, 10.25 mmol). After stirring overnight at RT, the reaction was concentrated to dryness and the solid residue treated with   1N   
HCl to pH 2-3. The viscous mixture was diluted with H2O (50 mL) and extracted with 20% Et2O/THF (1 x 100 mL). The organic extract was washed with H2O (1 x 25 mL) and brine (2 x 25 mL) and dried (MgSO4). Filtration and evaporation provided 0.93 g of crude product which was recrystallized from MeCN (25 mL) to give 0.657 g   (69k)    of BX67 as a beige powder: MS (ESP+ 



  Preparation of MX3
A. To a solution of Z-Asp(OtBu) (1.00 g, 3.09 mmol) in anhydrous DME (8 mL) at -200C under N2 was added, in order, Nmethylmorpholine (0.34 mL, 3.09 mmol) and isobutyl chloroformate
 (0.40 mL, 3.09 mmol). After 5 min, the reaction was filtered through glass wool to remove solids. To the filtrate was added ethereal CH2N2 (ca. 4.64 mmol) at   OOC.    After 30 min, excess CH2N2 was removed by bubbling a stream of dry N2 through the reaction for 10 min. The reaction was concentrated to dryness and the residue dissolved in MeOH (16 mL) to which was added a solution of silver benzoate (0.14 g, 0.62 mmol) in Et3N (1.55 mL) at RT.



  After stirring 30 min, the reaction was evaporated to dryness, the residue dissolved in EtOAc, and this solution passed through a pad of   Six2.    The filtrate was washed with 5% NaHCO3 (3x), H2O
   (lox),    5% citric acid (3x), and brine (2x), and dried (MgSO4).



  Filtration and evaporation provided crude product as an oil
 (0.70 g,   64%):    MS (FAB) 348; TLC (20% EtOAc/hexane)   Ref=0.30;    1H
NMR (CDCl3, 300 MHz, ppm) 7.35-7.27 (m, 5H), 5.72 and 5.58 (br d, 1H, 8.9 Hz), 5.10 and 5.06 (s, 2H), 4.60-4.51 and 4.36-4.29 (m, 1H), 3.73 and 3.64 (s, 3H), 2.75-2.47 (m, 4H), 1.40 (s, 9H).



  B. A solution of the above product (0.70 g, 1.99 mmol) in MeOH
 (3 mL) was treated with   1N    NaOH (3 mL) at RT. After stirring 1 hr, the reaction was judged complete by TLC analysis. The MeOH was removed by rotary evaporation. The residue was diluted with
H2O and extracted with Et2O (3x). These extracts were discarded.



  The aqueous was made acidic   (pH    4) by addition of 1M NaHSO4 and extracted with EtOAc (3x). The combined EtOAc extracts were washed with H2O (lx), and brine (lx), and dried (MgSO4). The  product was obtained as an oil (0.52 g,   77):    MS (FAB) 338   (M+H),    360 (M+Na); TLC (1:1 EtOAc/CHCl3) Rf=0.13; 1H NMR   (CDCl3,    300 MHz, ppm)   7.33-7.28    (m, 5H), 5.77 and 5.63   (d,lH,      J=8 .7    Hz), 5.11 and 5.07 (s, 2H), 4.63-4.58 and 4.37-4.30 (m, 1H), 2.782.50 (m, 4H), 1.40 (s, 9H).



  C. A mixture of DCC (1.85 g, 8.95 mmol) and HOBT (1.37 g, 8.95 mmol) in EtOAc (55 mL) was stirred at RT 20 min until homogeneous. The product of part B (3.02 g, 8.95 mmol), 4methoxybenzylamine (1.17 mL, 8.95 mmol), and N-methylmorpholine
 (1.97 mL, 17.9 mmol) were then added. After stirring overnight, the reaction was filtered to remove solids and the cake washed with fresh EtOAc (50 mL). The filtrate was washed with H20 (2x), 5% citric acid (lx), 5% NaHCO3 (1x), and brine (1x), and dried
 (MgSO4).

   Flash column chromatography on SiO2 eluting with 100%
CHC13 followed by 10% EtOAc/CHCl3 provided product as a white solid (3.41 g,   83%):    mp=100-1020C; MS   (FAB)    457; TLC (9:1
CHCl3/MeOH) Rf=0.71; 1H NMR (CDCl3, 300 MHz, ppm) 7.33-7.27 (m, 5H), 7.16 (d, 2H, J=8.6 Hz), 6.82 (d, 2H, J=8.7 Hz), 6.06 (br s, 1H), 5.89 (br d, 1H), 5.04 (s, 2H), 4.31 (d, 2H, J=5.6 Hz), 4.31-4.22 (m, 1H), 3.76 (s, 3H), 2.68-2.44 (m, 4H), 1.39 (s,   9H).   



  D. A suspension of this product (0.50 g, 1.1 mmol) and Degussa type E101 NE/W 10% Pd/C (0.117 g) in MeOH (20 mL) was hydrogenolyzed under 25 psi H2 for 18 hr. The reaction was filtered through Celite, rinsing with MeOH. The filtrate was evaporated to dryness. The product was obtained as a colorless oil (0.36 g,   100%):    MS   (FAB)    323; TLC (9:1   CHC13/MeOH)    Rf=0.30;    1H    NMR (CDCl3, 300 MHz, ppm) 7.58 (br s, 1H), 7.15 (d, 2H, J=8.6
Hz), 6.79 (d, 2H, J=8.6 Hz), 4.30 (d, 2H, J=6.50 Hz), 3.74 (s, 3H), 3.54 (m, 1H), 3.15 (br s, 2H),   2.46-2.29    (m, 4H), 1.40 (s, 9H).



  E. The product from part D (0.36 g, 1.1 mmol) and Eschenmoser's salt (0.204 g, 1.1 mmol) were refluxed in MeCN (10 mL) under an inert atmosphere for 42 hr. The reaction was cooled to RT and evaporated to dryness. The residue was diluted with 5% NaHCO3 and extracted with EtOAc (3x). The combined organic extracts were washed with 5% NaHCO3 (Ix),   H20      (lx),    and brine (1x), and dried (MgSO4).

   Flash column chromatography with a CHCl3/EtOAc gradient provided the product as an oil (0.19 g, 51%: MS (FAB) 335; TLC (1:1 EtOAc/CHCl3) Rf=0.22; ÚH NMR (CDCl3, 300 MHz, ppm) 7.16 (d, 2H,   J=8 .6    Hz), 6.81 (d,   2X,      J=8 .6    Hz), 4.64 (A of AB, 1H,   J=14.6    Hz), 4.27 (B of AB, 1H,   J=14.6    Hz), 4.10 (ABq, 2H,
J=11.7 Hz), 3.75 (s, 3H), 3.28 (m, 1H), 2.50 (dd, 1H, J=4.4, 17.2 Hz), 2.37 (AB of ABX, 2H,   J=15.8    Hz), 2.24 (dd, 1H, J=11.2, 17.2 Hz), 1.99 (br s, 1H), 1.40 (s, 9H).



  F. A mixture of o-tolylureidophenylacetic acid (3.53 g, 12.4 mmol), H-Leu-OtBu.HCl (2.78 g, 12.4 mmol), TBTU (3.98 g, 12.4 mmol), and iPr2NEt (4.32 mL, 24.8 mmmol) in DMF (25 mL) was stirred overnight at RT. The product was precipitated by addition of   H20    (10 mL). The solids were collected by filtration on a medium frit, washing with 2:1 DMF/H20 (35 mL), H20 (25 mL), and Et2O (2 x 25   mL),    and dried on the filter (4.18 g, 74%). All of this product was suspended in CH2C12 (16 mL) and treated with
TFA (16 mL) and stirred at RT 2 hr. The reaction was  concentrated to a syrup which was evaporated from CH2Cl2 (2 x 20 mL). The residue was triturated with Et2O (100mL) at RT for 2 hr.

   The solids were collected by filtration on a medium frit, washing with Et2O (50 mL), and dried on the filter (3.40 g,   93W):   
MS   (FAd3)    398.



  H. The product from step G (0.66 g, 1.96 mmol), the product of part F (0.78 g, 1.96 mmol) and EDC (0.410 g, 2.14 mmol) were stirred in NMP (4 mL) at RT for 48 hr. The reaction was poured into EtOAc (60 mL), washed with H2O (8 x 6 mL), brine (lx), and dried (MgSO4). The desired diastereomer was isolated pure (0.34 g, 24%) by repeated flash column chromatography using 1:1
EtOAc/CH2Cl2: MS (ESP+) 714.3; TLC (100% EtOAc) Rf=0.53; 1H NMR (CDCl3, 300 MHz, ppm) 7.53-7.43 (m, 2H), 7.20-7.00 (m, 9H), 6.806.73 (m, 2H), 6.45-6.33 (m,   1W),    5.31-4.58 (m, 4H), 4.21-4.00
 (m,   1H),    3.73 (s, 3H), 3.41 (s, 2H), 2.74-2.35 (m, 4H), 2.14 (s, 3H), 1.36 (s, 9H), 1.56-1.05 (m, 3H), 0.88, 0.82, 0.68, 0.63
 (4d, 6H total, J=6.17, 6.32, 6.46, 6.37 Hz, respectively).



  G. This product (0.34 g, 0.476 mmol) was stirred in TFA (3 mL) at RT for 3 hr. The reaction was concentrated to dryness and the residue evaporated from CH2Cl2 (3 x 3   mL).    The crude product was triturated with Et2O at RT, collected by filtration and dried on the filter. The product, MX3, was obtained as a light yellow solid (0.263 g,   84%):    MS (ESP+) 680.2 (M+Na); 1H NMR   (d6-DMSO,    300 MHz, ppm) consistent with structure and indicative of rotamers.  



   It will be apparent to those skilled in the art that various modifications and variations can be made in the methods and compositions of the present invention without departing from the spirit or scope of the invention. Thus, it is intended that the present invention cover the modifications and variations of this invention provided that they come within the scope of the appended claims and their equivalents.  



  Table 2
EMI155.1     


 <SEP> 0 <SEP> 0 <SEP> 0 <SEP> 0
<tb> B <SEP> u < S <SEP> B <SEP> ¯,/ <SEP> \¯( <SEP> %%)YQ%H0Th.
<tb>



   <SEP> I
<tb>  <SEP> Name: <SEP> AY4S <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> AV47 <SEP> Act <SEP> Name: <SEP> AY4s <SEP> Act
<tb> 3 <SEP> R
<tb>  <SEP> 8 <SEP> X
<tb>  <SEP> At <SEP> 4.Y
<tb> Name: <SEP> AY49 <SEP> Act <SEP> Name: <SEP> AY5o <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> AV5l <SEP> Act
<tb>  <SEP> HT. <SEP> z <SEP> wt
<tb>  <SEP> Wo <SEP> l <SEP> ; <SEP> 
<tb>     Structure-Activity 9 TABLE 3 52 Compounds Page 1   
EMI156.1     


<tb>  <SEP> D
<tb>  <SEP> "
<tb>  <SEP> a
<tb> Q
<tb>  <SEP> t
<tb>  <SEP> S <SEP> S-n
<tb>  <SEP> E
<tb>  <SEP> g <SEP> FX
<tb>  <SEP> .F < t
<tb>  <SEP> B <SEP> r <SEP> )
<tb>  <SEP> I
<tb>     Structure-Activity 9 TABLE 3 52 Compounds Page 2   
EMI157.1     


 <SEP> z <SEP> )¸o" <SEP> .
<tb>



   <SEP>  >  <SEP> 8 <SEP> ···
<tb> Name: <SEP> X <SEP> 3 <SEP> Act: <SEP> 3 <SEP> W
<tb>  <SEP> 1
<tb>  <SEP> S <SEP> ¯
<tb>  <SEP> it <SEP> w <SEP> |
<tb> a <SEP> F <SEP> .s <SEP> Z <SEP>  <  <SEP> ,l <SEP> ¯ <SEP> .s
<tb>  <SEP> X <SEP> yS
<tb> 9 <SEP> + > ! <SEP> ! <SEP>  >  < 
<tb> 3 <SEP>  <  <SEP> E <SEP> X <SEP> 3 <SEP> .X.
<tb>



   <SEP> X, <SEP> k <SEP> k.
<tb>



  i <SEP> S <SEP> S <SEP> ,5 <SEP> W <SEP> Se <SEP> S <SEP> X
<tb>     Structure-Activity 9 TABLE 3 52 Compounds Page 3   
EMI158.1     


<tb>  <SEP> 5- <SEP> 1
<tb>  <SEP> i <SEP> w
<tb>  <SEP> 1 <SEP> (0 > 
<tb>  <SEP> eSAx <SEP> i <SEP> '4.5 <SEP> 1-w5 <SEP> ¸','NO!··)
<tb> Ez <SEP>  <  <SEP> E <SEP> Name: <SEP> SY5S <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> sven <SEP> "
<tb>  <SEP> k <SEP> A
<tb>     Structure-Activity 9 TABLE 3 52 Compounds Page 4   
EMI159.1     


 <SEP> N" <SEP> N <SEP> N"N0 <SEP> N
<tb> 3Z <SEP> I <SEP> | <SEP> t0) <SEP> (¸0 <SEP> 3 <SEP> ffok·.
<tb>



   <SEP> a <SEP> m <SEP> 8'
<tb>  <SEP> t <SEP> Q.- <SEP> -k,
<tb>  <SEP> b <SEP> $
<tb>  <SEP> 'N"
<tb>  <SEP> %NN)%oNI··) <SEP> %""N!I·?· & 00) <SEP> (¸0%y¸ & 0)
<tb> NN
<tb>  <SEP> N <SEP> %NNYi¸¸· <SEP> NN <SEP> N
<tb>  <SEP> Name: <SEP> 5v7O <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> W <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> BYTS
<tb> Z <SEP> 2 <SEP>  <  <SEP> 3 <SEP> S
<tb> I <SEP>  < X, <SEP> W <SEP> W <SEP> e
<tb>     Structure-Activity 9 TABLE 3 52 Compounds Page 5   
EMI160.1     


<tb> z <SEP> 1 <SEP> zl <SEP> zl
<tb>  <SEP> N <SEP> N
<tb> li
<tb> ¹¸N.
<tb>



  ·"'NNN· <SEP> '3 <SEP>  <  <SEP> 3
<tb>  <SEP> t. <SEP> t- <SEP> t.
<tb>



  I <SEP> Act: <SEP> Narn: <SEP> BYSS <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> S <SEP> Act:
<tb>  <SEP> S <SEP> I
<tb>     Structure-Activity 9 TABLE 3 52 Compounds Page 6   
EMI161.1     


<tb>  <SEP> /7 <SEP> 91
<tb>  <SEP> y <SEP> N <SEP> N <SEP> ;%0$Ny¸ <SEP> Q%NJ%QN
<tb>  <SEP> E <SEP> X
<tb>  <SEP> Name: <SEP> CYIS <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name: <SEP> CYIS <SEP> Act: <SEP> Name:

   <SEP> CYi7 <SEP> Act':
<tb> z <SEP> z <SEP> Y
<tb>  <SEP> 3 <SEP> V4e <SEP> 3 <SEP>  <  <SEP> 3 <SEP>  < 
<tb>  <SEP> i
<tb>   
EMI162.1     


Company <SEP> Patent <SEP> Number <SEP> Preferred <SEP> Compound <SEP> Hybrid <SEP> Structure
<tb> Merck <SEP> -I <SEP> 478328 <SEP> HNQThI,,,,,cH <SEP> - <SEP> = <SEP> H
<tb>  <SEP> 3 <SEP> 3 <SEP> 3 <SEP> 3 <SEP> s
<tb>  <SEP> -c <SEP> n <SEP> o <SEP> 911
<tb> Merck <SEP> EP478362 <SEP> a <SEP> )kONH%)¸iH) <SEP> iDk,,',,1)(HN)CThj)A%%?iH
<tb> Merck <SEP> US <SEP> 5272158 <SEP> HNmM·y·.1CO2H <SEP> P <SEP> P <SEP> %i & )%)

  OjCOaH
<tb>  <SEP> US <SEP> 5227490 <SEP> Z <SEP> i2 <SEP> IYI
<tb> Merck <SEP> C <SEP> 93116697 <SEP> O <SEP> I <SEP> t <SEP> w
<tb>  <SEP> zr <SEP> IZ <SEP> IZ <SEP> =Z <SEP>   (Z
<tb>  <SEP> ? <SEP> Z <SEP> o <SEP> aZI <SEP> X <SEP> f <SEP> I
<tb>  <SEP> X <SEP> WS
<tb>   
EMI163.1     


Merck <SEP> US <SEP> 5294616 <SEP> o)Gic2w·$1 <SEP> mk <SEP> HN0
<tb> Merck <SEP> EP <SEP> 512829 <SEP> HN <SEP> )WNO2H <SEP> HN <SEP> (¸$IHN)LO)YI)¸o2H <SEP> 
<tb>  <SEP>  =D <SEP> B <SEP> o <SEP> on
<tb>  <SEP> m <SEP> m <SEP> 
<tb>  <SEP> Q <SEP> Q <SEP> Q <SEP> Q
<tb>  <SEP> :CZ <SEP> IZ <SEP> ZI <SEP> Z
<tb>  <SEP> ax <SEP> a <SEP> IZf <SEP> &verbar;

   <SEP> S
<tb>  <SEP> O <SEP> i <SEP> 9IZ3 <SEP> IZ <SEP> uY <SEP> Z
<tb>   
EMI164.1     


Merck <SEP> EP <SEP> 512831 <SEP> 0 <SEP> C1H3 <SEP> i) <SEP> H <SEP> ?H3
<tb>  <SEP> l <SEP> -- <SEP> 3 <SEP> K
<tb>  <SEP> ax <SEP> s <SEP> On
<tb>  <SEP> cn <SEP> (DkNN)¸Y1)lO <SEP> cn <SEP> X <SEP> n
<tb> Merck <SEP> EP <SEP> 512831 <SEP> HD· <SEP> O2H
<tb>  <SEP> NH
<tb> I <SEP> 1
<tb> Merck <SEP> US <SEP> 5389631 <SEP> cc2H <SEP> ZD
<tb>  <SEP> z
<tb> c <SEP> HN <SEP>  
<tb>  <SEP> e <SEP> R <SEP>  <  <SEP>  < 
<tb> IZ$o <SEP> E <SEP>  > S <SEP> IZ <SEP> AD
<tb> S <SEP> 8 <SEP> 2 <SEP> 8 <SEP> t <SEP> X <SEP> ?8e
<tb>   
EMI165.1     


<tb>  <SEP> - <SEP> OQ2H
<tb> a
<tb>  <SEP> N <SEP> N
<tb>  <SEP> H <SEP> 0 <SEP> 'r-N <SEP> H
<tb>  <SEP> NN <SEP> H
<tb>  <SEP> t
<tb>  <SEP> cn
<tb>  <SEP> X
<tb>  <SEP>  st
<tb>  <SEP> So
<tb>  <SEP> TZ
<tb>  <SEP> 0ta
<tb>  <SEP> ztz,

  
<tb>  <SEP> TZS
<tb>  <SEP> s
<tb>  <SEP> sz)=o
<tb>  <SEP> Tt
<tb>  <SEP> sS
<tb>  <SEP> z.zz
<tb>  <SEP> sz < t
<tb>   
EMI166.1     


 <SEP> CO2H <SEP> CO2H
<tb> Merck <SEP> US <SEP> 5358956 <SEP> U
<tb>  <SEP> GB <SEP> 2271567 <SEP> HN <SEP> I <SEP> y1N-?
<tb>  <SEP> 0 <SEP> OoO
<tb>  <SEP> HThN¸ftHTh <SEP> )/ <SEP> ¸csTh
<tb>  <SEP> i & UYoU)M¹I$\HQ)iiH
<tb>  <SEP> H <SEP> N <SEP> U
<tb>  <SEP> Merck <SEP> US <SEP> 5334596 <SEP> 1\0 <SEP> HcOH <SEP> Yo <SEP> %N00
<tb>  <SEP> WO <SEP> 94126745 <SEP> 1S\ <SEP> 
<tb>  <SEP> ftHco2H
<tb>  <SEP> E <SEP> K <SEP> = <SEP> Ï <SEP> K
<tb>  <SEP> o <SEP> o <SEP> X <SEP> m <SEP> w <SEP> 
<tb>  <SEP> t7 <SEP>  >  <SEP> ,
<tb>  <SEP> SZ+1 <SEP> -Zz  
<tb>   
EMI167.1     


 <SEP> MN
<tb>  <SEP> Merck <SEP> US <SEP> 5334598 <SEP> N16\0co2 <SEP> I,' <SEP> 0 <SEP> Th%)%&num;

  \0 <SEP> Hst1COH
<tb>  <SEP> WO <SEP> 94126745 <SEP> HN
<tb>  <SEP> t <SEP> w <SEP> 7 <SEP> r <SEP> w
<tb>  <SEP> B <SEP> B <SEP> o <SEP> B
<tb>  <SEP> Merck <SEP> WO <SEP> x
<tb> e <SEP> e <SEP> e <SEP> 4I3
<tb>  <SEP> o, <SEP> o, <SEP> WO <SEP> 94108962 <SEP> ¯ <SEP> v <SEP> i))t <SEP> 1
<tb>  <SEP> H <SEP> N
<tb>  <SEP> Merck <SEP> WO <SEP> 9 <SEP> Q
<tb>  <SEP> 1 <SEP> k <SEP> ,P
<tb>  <SEP> Merck <SEP> WO <SEP> 94108962 <SEP> H <SEP> OSC7$/H <SEP> (i$k) <SEP> )[ <SEP>  >  <SEP> H
<tb>  <SEP> TZ <SEP>   <SEP> IZ <SEP> O Zz <SEP> o ZI
<tb>  <SEP> ok, <SEP> 1
<tb>  <SEP> LA <SEP> 8 <SEP> 58
<tb>   
EMI168.1     


 <SEP> Me4
<tb>  <SEP> CO2H <SEP> I <SEP> O2I
<tb>  <SEP> 0
<tb>  <SEP> Merck <SEP> WO <SEP> 94/22825 <SEP> H&num;

  41""H <SEP> yLw5( <SEP> I <SEP> HN <SEP> 2
<tb>  <SEP> H <SEP> NO
<tb>  <SEP> 6 <SEP> B <SEP> oS <SEP> 5 <SEP> S <SEP> o
<tb>  <SEP> Merck <SEP> WO <SEP> 94112181 <SEP> INCO2H <SEP> I <SEP> ,,,,o <SEP> X
<tb>  <SEP> Me <SEP> Me
<tb>  <SEP> (D <SEP> EP <SEP>  < eD <SEP> n <SEP> S
<tb>  <SEP> 02 <SEP> , <SEP> Me <SEP> IHN'\ <SEP> M
<tb>  <SEP> I <SEP> I <SEP> 02H
<tb>  <SEP> Me
<tb>  <SEP> Merck <SEP> WO <SEP> 94/18981 <SEP> CO2H <SEP> 4·0S0Me
<tb>  <SEP> O <SEP> CO2H
<tb>  <SEP> I <SEP> o <SEP>   <SEP> o <SEP> C
<tb>  <SEP> ZI <SEP> e <SEP> 9 <SEP>  >  <SEP> =
<tb>  <SEP> 0  <SEP> O ZI <SEP> IZ > O <SEP> 0d <SEP> s0
<tb> (X <SEP> C) <SEP> t <SEP> eX <SEP> 0A,
<tb>  <SEP> I <SEP> ZS <SEP> O <SEP> A  <SEP> IZX
<tb>  <SEP> s <SEP> We <SEP> s <SEP> g <SEP> s <SEP> e <SEP> s¯t)
<tb>   
EMI169.1     


 <SEP> Merck <SEP> WO <SEP> 94118981 <SEP> HNQw <SEP> 0 <SEP> N.80MC <SEP> %r1)

  Y0 <SEP> HN.S0Me
<tb>  <SEP> f·0co2 <SEP> ¸N'o <SEP> NHCO2H
<tb>  <SEP> Merck <SEP> EP <SEP> 623615 <SEP> N <SEP> CO2H <SEP> ,YNCO2H
<tb> Iermany <SEP> US <SEP> 5532255 <SEP> H2NHNO
<tb>  <SEP> Merck <SEP> EP <SEP> 645376 <SEP> H2Ni <SEP> NO/ <SEP> \
<tb> IGermany <SEP> HN <SEP> CO2H <SEP> OcO2H
<tb>  <SEP> H2N&num;

  ·\\N± <SEP> cO2H <SEP> 0N <SEP> N <SEP> C <SEP> 02 <SEP> H
<tb>  <SEP> Merck <SEP> GB <SEP> 2292558 <SEP> H <SEP> N01 <SEP> NC02H <SEP> /\O <SEP> c02H
<tb>  <SEP> O <SEP> 5 <SEP> O <SEP> t <SEP> ¯
<tb>  <SEP> o <SEP> 3  <SEP> 8- <SEP> 86
<tb>  <SEP> w <SEP> m <SEP> X <SEP> C <SEP> mm <SEP> O
<tb>  <SEP> 0 <SEP> 8
<tb>  <SEP> oJszs <SEP> z <SEP> 9 <SEP> ¯ <SEP> ZI
<tb>  <SEP> A <SEP> = <SEP> r
<tb>   
EMI170.1     


 <SEP> Merck <SEP> H2N
<tb>  <SEP> IGermany <SEP> EP <SEP> 711770 <SEP> QQNN·ThNco2H <SEP> 0 <SEP> - <SEP> NTh
<tb>  <SEP> NyO <SEP> Qco2H
<tb>  <SEP> 0 <SEP> ct) <SEP> D <SEP> P
<tb>  <SEP> coa,
<tb>  <SEP>   <SEP> EP <SEP> n <SEP> mm
<tb> 0 <SEP> HNv0 <SEP> 0 <SEP> HN
<tb>  <SEP> a <SEP> US <SEP> 5250879 <SEP> H2N$i <SEP>   <SEP> J
<tb>  <SEP> tech <SEP> i0Y&num;

  /
<tb>  <SEP> M <SEP> WO <SEP> 93108174 <SEP> H2N <SEP> I
<tb>  <SEP> o <SEP> o
<tb>  <SEP> h <SEP> z
<tb>  <SEP> fs <SEP> X
<tb>   
EMI171.1     


 <SEP> Gtr1c <SEP> US <SEP> 5403836 <SEP> H2ti%·l <SEP> ON02 <SEP> H <SEP> Y0 <SEP> ONCO2 <SEP> H
<tb>  <SEP> NH <SEP> OM. <SEP> 0OM.
<tb>



   <SEP> . <SEP> 0= <SEP> E <SEP> ag
<tb>  <SEP> 1 <SEP> 1 <SEP> 0¯ <SEP> 
<tb>  <SEP> EP <SEP> QI <SEP> 2
<tb>  <SEP> coaH <SEP> I
<tb>  <SEP> Ze <SEP> ,Ze <SEP> c <SEP> mC <SEP> c
<tb>  <SEP> Searle <SEP> US <SEP> 5220050 <SEP> H2N <SEP> 0  <SEP> '¸O02H <SEP> ) <SEP> ms <SEP> s <SEP> v
<tb>  <SEP> IU <SEP> O <SEP> pW <SEP> (D
<tb> US <SEP> 5239113
<tb>  <SEP> Monsanto <SEP> WO <SEP> p <SEP> H2)4NIco2 <SEP> )ck)co2H
<tb>  <SEP> EP <SEP> 542708 <SEP> 0 <SEP> 0
<tb>  <SEP> US <SEP> 5272162 <SEP> HN <SEP> Yo <SEP> i·I)Nco2H
<tb>  <SEP> Searle <SEP> WO <SEP> z <SEP> ZI
<tb>  <SEP> v <SEP> bc <SEP> oS
<tb>   
EMI172.1     


 <SEP> Searle <SEP> US <SEP> 5344957 <SEP> H2NH)4Nij4
<tb>  <SEP> CO2H <SEP> CO2H
<tb>  <SEP> HN
<tb>  <SEP> 1 <SEP> A <SEP> WO <SEP> 0C
<tb>  <SEP> t <SEP> c <SEP> Z <SEP> c
<tb>  <SEP> Monsanto <SEP> US <SEP> 5314902 <SEP> H2NH)

  4N1 <SEP> i5r0 <SEP> 
<tb>  <SEP> N <SEP> N1oO2H <SEP> N <SEP> C02H
<tb>  <SEP> I <SEP> Z <SEP> I <SEP> N
<tb>  <SEP> z <SEP> WO <SEP> 93116038 <SEP> H2Ny·$ <SEP> I
<tb>  <SEP> C <SEP> ·oN)iC·) <SEP> I
<tb>  <SEP> HN
<tb> ; <SEP> \ <SEP> s <SEP> WO <SEP> 94100424 <SEP> H2N <SEP> (WY0)Th··$
<tb>  <SEP> X <SEP> 0
<tb>   
EMI173.1     


 <SEP> Searle
<tb>  <SEP> Monsanto <SEP> WO <SEP> 94/18162 <SEP> N <SEP> CO2H
<tb>  <SEP> CO2H
<tb>  <SEP>  <  <SEP> D <SEP>  <  <SEP> U <SEP> cn <SEP> cn <SEP> o <SEP> Ch <SEP> o <SEP> tn
<tb>  <SEP> Searle <SEP> WO <SEP> cnP, <SEP> NH <SEP> 1)N
<tb>  <SEP> Monsanto <SEP> COH <SEP> IoINNco2H
<tb>  <SEP> H2N
<tb> 002H <SEP> 002H
<tb> o, <SEP> o <SEP> WO <SEP> ON <SEP>  
<tb>  <SEP> 0 <SEP> WO <SEP> 94/22820 <SEP> h) <SEP> COaH <SEP> t
<tb>  <SEP> VI <SEP> O <SEP> 0, <SEP> Q,
<tb>  <SEP> HN
<tb>  <SEP> ,

  I <SEP> OMOO2H <SEP> CO2H
<tb>  <SEP> JI <SEP> US <SEP> 5523302 <SEP> · <SEP> ··1OMe <SEP> · <SEP> · <SEP> OMe
<tb>  <SEP> HN) <SEP> 0 <SEP> I <SEP> tz
<tb>  <SEP> 0 <SEP> --Z <SEP> US <SEP> 5446056 <SEP> 2N&num;¸Thr/\0o <SEP> UC02H <SEP> mMN-o <SEP> cO2H
<tb>  <SEP>  >  <SEP> 9 <SEP>  <  <SEP> s <SEP> eS <SEP> eS
<tb>  <SEP> o < ZZTI <SEP> SZ   <SEP> e <SEP> s <SEP>  =( <SEP>   zs
<tb>  <SEP> P <SEP> C <SEP> ,

   <SEP> W°  <SEP> ino <SEP> 48
<tb>   
EMI174.1     


 <SEP> DuPont <SEP> WO <SEP> 95118111 <SEP> H <SEP> HNfS2\ <SEP> H <SEP> N.S0± <SEP> \/
<tb>  <SEP> Merck <SEP> H <SEP> NCO2H <SEP> CQ2H
<tb>  <SEP> 3 <SEP> U <SEP> U <SEP> 3= <SEP> 3 <SEP> 5m
<tb>  <SEP> Thomae <SEP> O <SEP> P <SEP> 718287 <SEP> NmN/\2tN <SEP> O <SEP> ZD <SEP> ¯
<tb>  <SEP> m <SEP> Xm <SEP> X <SEP> Um <SEP> m <SEP>  
<tb>  <SEP> Thomae <SEP> EP <SEP> 525629 <SEP> H2··\/\--N <SEP> OH <SEP> 'QmkN=N/\-·ONOO2MC
<tb>  <SEP> NMe
<tb> S^D <SEP> EP <SEP> -' <SEP> ' <SEP> X <SEP> ZI <SEP> cO2H
<tb> Thomae <SEP> EP <SEP> 604800 <SEP> IIO2
<tb>  <SEP> g <SEP> I <SEP> I <SEP> O <SEP> O <SEP> X <SEP> 0 <SEP> I
<tb>  <SEP> SZ <SEP> S <SEP> 01= <SEP> SZ <SEP> ZI <SEP> Q
<tb>  <SEP> to <SEP> oNk <SEP> C,

  lz <SEP> t <SEP> t <SEP> zzi
<tb>  <SEP> TZg <SEP> 4 <SEP> sZa <SEP> O <SEP> = <SEP> o <SEP> z <SEP> Xt
<tb>   
EMI175.1     


Thomae <SEP> EP <SEP> 503548 <SEP> H2N <SEP> C02H <SEP> 1N?:oo2H
<tb>  <SEP> HN
<tb>  <SEP> OMe <SEP> OMe
<tb> I  <SEP> T <SEP> 3 <SEP> EP <SEP> S
<tb> C <SEP> H2N <SEP> N <SEP> m <SEP> m
<tb>  <SEP> HN
<tb> ui <SEP> Me <SEP> 0 <SEP> S <SEP> MCc <SEP> H
<tb> iu <SEP> US <SEP> 5399585 <SEP> H2NHNl/0O2H <SEP> o
<tb>  <SEP> mico <SEP> ot <SEP> w
<tb> Iw <SEP> Sx <SEP> Tx <SEP> US <SEP> 5256812 <SEP> W <SEP> I)MIeoOCO2H <SEP> )·i;

  )·oco2
<tb>  <SEP> HN <SEP> f <SEP> NN
<tb>  <SEP> IZ <SEP> SZ <SEP> SZ <SEP> SZ
<tb>  <SEP> f <SEP> st <SEP> t <SEP> Azg
<tb>   
EMI176.1     


<tb>  <SEP> on <SEP>   <SEP> g <SEP> z <SEP> s <SEP> s <SEP> s <SEP> s
<tb>  <SEP> ED <SEP> m <SEP> m <SEP> c <SEP>   <SEP> X <SEP> co
<tb> TZs <SEP>  <  <SEP>  <  <SEP> W-e <SEP>  < 
<tb>  <SEP> t <SEP> &num;

   <SEP> 4 <SEP> L <SEP> j
<tb>  <SEP> Hoffman <SEP> US <SEP> 5084466 <SEP> ¸ <SEP> MWc02H <SEP> 10C02H
<tb>  <SEP> LaRoche <SEP> EP <SEP> 381033 <SEP> H%NN <SEP> IyI)NI)N
<tb>  <SEP> Rhone- <SEP> WO <SEP> 93/11759 <SEP> HH2NN <SEP> N <SEP> NH <SEP> "'-ON <SEP> NH
<tb>  <SEP> PouIenc <SEP> US <SEP> 5258398 <SEP> H2N <SEP> N <SEP> CO2H <SEP> (%Yo&num;&num;co
<tb>  <SEP> F <SEP> CO2H
<tb>  <SEP> I <SEP> I
<tb>  <SEP> HN <SEP> N
<tb>  <SEP> Takeda <SEP> EP <SEP> 614664
<tb>  <SEP> (Hoechst) <SEP> WO <SEP> 94/17034 <SEP> H2NyGrmNNQ <SEP> N)))N <SEP> l)%Y)NN)LN
<tb>  <SEP> HN
<tb>   
Table 3
EMI177.1     


GIaxoEPS37980 <SEP> H2N/\N <SEP> H <SEP> N <SEP> H
<tb>  <SEP> 0 <SEP> 93/08181 <SEP> H <SEP> N'-"j <SEP> I
<tb>  <SEP> co2H <SEP> 0 <SEP> 002H
<tb>  <SEP> a <SEP> I <SEP> I
<tb>  <SEP> WO <SEP> 93110091 <SEP> HNN & I <SEP> D <SEP> G) <SEP> )(
<tb>  <SEP> II <SEP> e: <SEP> e! <SEP> P:

   <SEP> e!
<tb>  <SEP> x
<tb>  <SEP> o <SEP> s <SEP> o <SEP> o <SEP> o
<tb>  <SEP> I <SEP> o <SEP> o <SEP> o <SEP> O" <SEP> gm
<tb>  <SEP> 9 <SEP> -o
<tb>  <SEP> co <SEP> (o <SEP> cr, <SEP> "5 <SEP> U""
<tb>  <SEP> 2 <SEP> L!lu <SEP> W
<tb> G <SEP> laxo <SEP> WO <SEP> 93/14077 <SEP> H2NN\JJm%H <SEP> CH2
<tb>  <SEP> Br <SEP> Br
<tb>  <SEP> OT <SEP> ZT <SEP> IZ <SEP> ZS <SEP> ZI
<tb>  <SEP> S <SEP> z? <SEP> S <SEP> Ce
<tb>  <SEP> b <SEP> Cz) <SEP> z-X <SEP> b <SEP> - < 
<tb>  <SEP> al <SEP> I <SEP> I <SEP> O <SEP> I <SEP> O
<tb>   
EMI178.1     


 <SEP> Smith- <SEP> H2iNI <SEP> N <SEP> (i5rO1$N
<tb>  <SEP> Kline <SEP> WO <SEP> 93/00095 <SEP> Io <SEP> oI0
<tb>  <SEP> Beecham
<tb> CO2H <SEP> aW <SEP> 7R <SEP> en <SEP> W <SEP> tn
<tb>  <SEP> S <SEP> 5 <SEP> 3 <SEP> s <SEP> 3
<tb>  <SEP> Smith- <SEP> J <SEP> 3 <SEP> NH1 <SEP> pa,

  
<tb>  <SEP> Kline <SEP> WO <SEP> 94/12478 <SEP> Z
<tb>  <SEP> Ï <SEP> N <SEP> Ï <SEP> C02H <SEP> N <SEP> 02H
<tb>  <SEP> tr, <SEP> co <SEP> co <SEP> cr,
<tb>  <SEP> O) <SEP> a, <SEP> I <SEP> N <SEP> 0
<tb>  <SEP> I <SEP> I <SEP> I
<tb>  <SEP> Z <SEP> O <SEP> SI <SEP> SI <SEP> "JZ <SEP> I
<tb>  <SEP> CO2H
<tb>  <SEP> H2N <SEP> ¸'
<tb>  <SEP> " <SEP> 0CO2H <SEP> ,,,,,o <SEP> 0 <SEP> Co2H
<tb>  <SEP> Kline <SEP> WO <SEP> 94/22444 <SEP> /N1 <SEP> /NNj
<tb>  <SEP> Beecham
<tb>  <SEP> · <SEP>   <SEP> A <SEP> ·
<tb>  <SEP> W <SEP> s <SEP>  >  <SEP> e
<tb>  <SEP> Z <SEP> IZ <SEP> od2T <SEP> 0 
<tb>  <SEP> Wd <SEP> % <SEP> X <SEP> b
<tb>  <SEP> cZz¯ <SEP> / <SEP> µ=  <SEP> O=AZI <SEP>  4 <SEP> I
<tb>   
EMI179.1     


 <SEP> Smith- <SEP> H2N
<tb>  <SEP> Kline <SEP> WO <SEP> 94/29273 <SEP> H·% <SEP> ',,-o
<tb>  <SEP> Beecham <SEP> 0 <SEP> 1)

  0NO02H <SEP> 0 <SEP> 0CO2H
<tb>  <SEP> W <SEP> 
<tb>  <SEP> o  <SEP> z <SEP> 3 <SEP> zr <SEP> H2?N
<tb>  <SEP> Kline <SEP> WO <SEP> 94/29273 <SEP>  
<tb>  <SEP> Ï <SEP> E <SEP> Ï <SEP> Ï <SEP> --
<tb>  <SEP> Smith- <SEP> M
<tb> h) <SEP> Q, <SEP> Q) <SEP> WO <SEP> h)
<tb>  <SEP> -- <SEP> Fe-- <SEP> X?
<tb>  <SEP> I <SEP> I <SEP> NI <SEP> HN010
<tb>  <SEP> N <SEP> N <SEP> O02H
<tb>  <SEP> ? <SEP> O <SEP> zt <SEP> o <SEP> (o
<tb>  <SEP> 0 <SEP> 0 <SEP> H <SEP> N <SEP> N
<tb>  <SEP> 9 <SEP> s <SEP> s <SEP>  >  <SEP>  > 
<tb>  <SEP> IZ <SEP> IZ <SEP> IZ <SEP> o ZI <SEP> O ZI
<tb>  <SEP>  <  <SEP> b <SEP> t <SEP> b <SEP>  
<tb>  <SEP> F <SEP> AZI & o <SEP>   <SEP> O4ZI <SEP>  oZT
<tb>  <SEP> l <SEP> eTerZztz.g <SEP> A <SEP> R  <SEP> O <SEP> = <SEP> 8
<tb>  <SEP> O <SEP> o <SEP>   <SEP> O <SEP> o <SEP> I
<tb>   
EMI180.1     


<tb>  <SEP> W
<tb>  <SEP> 3 <SEP> SD <SEP> r
<tb>  <SEP> 3 

  <SEP> 1
<tb>  <SEP> Ï
<tb>  <SEP> ZD
<tb>  <SEP> I <SEP> a)
<tb>  <SEP> l <SEP> 
<tb>  <SEP> I <SEP> aa
<tb>  <SEP> ro
<tb>  <SEP> Q
<tb>  <SEP> X
<tb>  <SEP> Fo
<tb>  <SEP> R
<tb>  <SEP> X
<tb>  <SEP> O
<tb>  <SEP> s
<tb>  <SEP> l <SEP> IZ
<tb>  <SEP> Dco
<tb>  <SEP> IZ
<tb>  <SEP> WI
<tb>  <SEP> I <SEP> J
<tb>  <SEP> to
<tb>  <SEP> O
<tb>  <SEP> oX
<tb>  <SEP> NI
<tb>  <SEP> I
<tb>   
EMI181.1     


 <SEP> CO2H <SEP> QN <SEP> I <SEP> NcO2H
<tb>  <SEP> S
<tb>  <SEP> Ir,,NH <SEP> IN5/&num;NH
<tb>  <SEP> Sanofi <SEP> EP <SEP> 719775 <SEP> H2N1 <SEP> 1N <SEP> N1""' <SEP> N
<tb>  <SEP> HN <SEP> N <SEP> OO2H
<tb>  <SEP> m <SEP> t <SEP> m <SEP> 1 <SEP> m <SEP> &verbar; <SEP> i <SEP> L
<tb>  <SEP> mm <SEP> mm <SEP> m <SEP> mX <SEP>  
<tb>  <SEP> o, <SEP> o, <SEP> o,
<tb>  <SEP> f:

   <SEP> =
<tb>  <SEP> Eli <SEP> Lilly <SEP> EP <SEP> 635492 <SEP> p <SEP> =1 <SEP> ""'0""'o)Ai0co
<tb>  <SEP> H2N
<tb>  <SEP> z <SEP> i
<tb>  <SEP> 0
<tb>  <SEP> Eli <SEP> Lilly <SEP> CI <SEP> o
<tb>  <SEP> O <SEP> I <SEP> I
<tb>  <SEP> ZS <SEP> Zl; <SEP> ZS <SEP> s <SEP> IZ
<tb>  <SEP> Z0I <SEP> ZI <SEP> of <SEP> 0 <SEP> 2 <SEP> IZ <SEP> S <SEP> Xz
<tb> N <SEP> X <SEP> AoE <SEP> AoS <SEP> \rZC
<tb> I <SEP> D <SEP> X <SEP> O <SEP> H
<tb>   
EMI182.1     


<tb>  <SEP> CO2H
<tb>  <SEP> Ortflo <SEP> WO <SEP> 95/25091 <SEP> H <SEP> N <SEP> N <SEP> N <SEP> 2 <SEP> i) <SEP> N <SEP> N <SEP> N
<tb>  <SEP> N & I
<tb>  <SEP> N <SEP> t <SEP> oN <SEP> o
<tb>  <SEP> U) <SEP> U)

   <SEP> X <SEP> O <SEP>  
<tb>  <SEP> wBo <SEP> o <SEP> t <SEP> (o <SEP> 94/22834 <SEP> NQo0O2H <SEP> 01100O2H
<tb>  <SEP> 0 <SEP> cO2H
<tb>  <SEP> Zensce <SEP> EP <SEP> 632016 <SEP> -Z <SEP> I <SEP> "00Ni <SEP> O-NOO2H
<tb> US <SEP> 5463011 <SEP> H2NHO <SEP> 2 <SEP> 002H
<tb>  <SEP> ei <SEP> n <SEP> /Z
 <SEP> A\R <SEP> (=
<tb>   
EMI183.1     


 <SEP> HN
<tb>  <SEP> Eli <SEP> ilIy <SEP> WO <SEP> 96/22288 <SEP> H2N <SEP> )·t)CO2H <SEP> ',,,'OONCO2H
<tb>  <SEP> H·jmrN(% <SEP> CO2H
<tb>  <SEP> 0 <SEP> 0 <SEP> CO2H
<tb>  <SEP> Fujisawa <SEP> WO <SEP> 96/29309 <SEP> 00$i
<tb>  <SEP> ;CNCO2H <SEP> r&num;NCNCO2H
<tb>  <SEP> Merck <SEP> N <SEP> 0 <SEP> COH <SEP> 0N0 <SEP> CO2H
<tb>  <SEP> /Germany <SEP> EP <SEP> 727425 <SEP> H2iNI <SEP> YO <SEP> 2
<tb>  <SEP> Z.: <SEP> v <SEP> Ez'
<tb> 1
<tb>  

Claims (1)

  1. What is claimed is: 1. A cell adhesion inhibitor comprising a compound having Formula (I) A-B (I) wherein A comprises a VLA-4 specificity determinant which does not impart significant IIb/IIIa activity, and B comprises an integrin scaffold.
    2. The inhibitor of claim 1 wherein said inhibitor has VLA-4 inhibitory activity and B comprises an integrin scaffold derived from a compound having IIb/IIIa activity.
    3. The cell adhesion inhibitor of claim 2 wherein B is selected from the group consisting of the integrin scaffolds of the compounds in Table 2.
    4. The cell adhesion inhibitor of claim 1 wherein B is a compound selected from the group consisting of Formula IIa, IIb and lIc EMI185.1 wherein A1 is selected from the group consisting of NRÚ, O, S, (CR1R2)r, and N[(CRÚRê)m(C=Y)AêRÚ]; A2 is selected from the group consisting of 0, NRê, S, and (CRÚRê)r; A3 is selected from the group consisting NR1, O, S, and (CR1R2)r; X is selected from the group consisting of H2, 0, and S; Y is H2, or O; r = 0, 1; n = 0-5;
    m = 1-4; W is selected from the group consisting of CO2H, SO3H, PO4H2, tetrazole, and H; Z is CO, or (CRÚRê)n, U is selected from the group consisting of COR12, (CRÚRê)nR12, and SO2R11; R1 and R2 are independently selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocycle; alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heterocycle, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, and carboxamide; R is RÚ, or amino acid side chains; R5 and R6 are independently selected from the group consisting of H, ORÚ, halogen, alkyl, SRÚ, NZR12, and NRÚRê; R11 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocycle;
    alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heterocycle, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, and carboxamide; and R12 is selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocycle; alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, heterocycle, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, carboxamide, and aralkoxy.
    5. The cell adhesion inhibitor of claim 2 wherein B comprises a scaffold selected from the group consisting of Formula IIIa, Formula IIIb and Formula IIIc EMI187.1 n = 0-5; m = 1-4; q = 1 or 2; r = O or 1; Y is H2 or 0; W is selected from the group consisting of CO2H, SO3H, PO4H2, tetrazole,and H; Z is CO or (CR1R2); R1 and R2 are independently selected from the group consisting of H; alkyl; alkenyl; alkynyl; cycloalkyl; cycloalkenyl; aryl; aralkyl; heterocycle; and alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heterocycle, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, or carboxamide; R7 is selected from the group consisting of H; aryl; substituted aryl; aralkyl; alkyl; alkenyl;
    alkyl optionally substituted with heterocycle, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, alkoxy, or halogen; R10 is selected from the group consisting of R2, NHSO2R1, NH2, ORê,and NHZR12; R12 is selected from the group consisting of H; alkyl; cycloalkenyl; aryl; aralkyl; heterocycle; and alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, heterocycle, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, carboxamide, or aralkoxy; R13 is H or -CH2(CH2)mCH2-; Rê and R7 may be taken together to form -(CH2)m-; Rê and R10 may be taken together to form -(CH2)m-; R11 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl; alkenyl; alkynyl; cycloalkyl; cycloalkenyl; aryl; aralkyl; heterocycle;
    and alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heterocycle, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, or carboxamide.
    6. The inhibitor of claim 2 wherein B comprises a scaffold selected from the group consisting of Formula IVa, Formula IVb and Formula IVc EMI188.1 EMI189.1 where in A4 is selected from the group consisting of (CRÚRê)n, O, S, NRÚ,SO2NRÚ, CONRÚ, CH2NR11, NRÚSO2, CH2O, CH2NCOR11, and CH2CONRÚ; n = 0-5; m = 1-4; W is selected from the group consisting of CO2H, SO3H, PO4H2, tetrazole, and H; Z is CO, or (CR1R2); R1 and R2 are independently selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocycle;
    alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heterocycle, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, and carboxamide; R4 is selected from the group consisting of H, OR1, SR1, NR1R2, alkyl, NZRÚ, NSO2R11; and CO2RÚ; R5 and R6 are independently selected from the group consisting of H, ORÚ, halogen, alkyl, and NRÚRê; and R11 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocycle; alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heterocycle, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, and carboxamide.
    7. The inhibitor of claim 2 wherein B comprises a scaffold having Formula Va or Vb EMI190.1 where in A3 is selected from the group consisting of NR1, O, S, and (CR R2)r; As is selected from the group consisting of SO,R11, COR7, and (CR1R2)nR7; n = 0-5; m = 1-4; r = 0, 1; W is selected from the group consisting of CO2H, SO3H, PO4H2, tetrazole, and H; P is CO, or SO2; RÚ and Rê are independently selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocycle;
    alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heterocycle, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, and carboxamide; R7 is selected from the group consisting of H, aryl, substituted aryl, aralkyl, alkyl, alkenyl; alkyl optionally substituted with heterocycle, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxy carbonyl, alkoxy, and halogen; When R8 is H, then R9 is R7, or Re and R9 can be taken together to form a 4-7 member ring optionally substituted with optionally substituted with hydroxyl, -ORÚ, -NÚRÚRê, -SRÚ, SO2R11, -SOR11; R11 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocycle;
    alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heterocycle, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, and carboxamide.
    8. A VLA-4 inhibitor selected from the group consisting of compounds 63, 64, and 66.
    9. A VLA-4 inhibitor selected from the group consisting of compounds 42, 44, 45, 46, 48, 49, 50, 51, 52 and 53.
    10. The cell adhesion inhibitor of claim 1 or 2 wherein A is selected from the group consisting of alkyl; aliphatic acyl optionally substituted with N-alkyl- or N-arylamido; aroyl; heterocycloyl; alkyl- or arylsulfonyl; aralkylcarbonyl optionally substituted with aryl; heterocycloalkylcarbonyl; alkoxycarbonyl; aralkyloxycarbonyl; cycloalkylcarbonyl optionally fused with aryl; heterocycloalkoxycarbonyl; alkylaminocarbonyl; arylamino carbonyl and aralkylaminocarbonyl optionally substituted with bis (alkylsulfonyl) amino, alkoxycarbonylamino or alkenyl; alkylsulfonyl; aralkylsulfonyl; arylsulfonyl; cycloalkylsulfonyl optionally fused with aryl; heterocyclylsulfonyl; heterocyclylalkylsulfonyl; aralkoxycarbonyl; aryloxycarbonyl; cycloalkyloxycarbonyl; heterocyclyloxycarbonyl; heterocyclylalkoxycarbonyl; mono- or di-alkylaminocarbonyl optionally substituted with aryl;
    (alkyl) (aralkyl) aminocarbonyl; mono- or di-aralkylaminocarbonyl; monoor di-arylaminocarbonyl; (aryl) (alkyl) aminocarbonyl; mono- or di-cycloalkylaminocarbonyl; heterocyclylaminocarbonyl; heterocyclylalkylaminocarbonyl; (alkyl) (heterocyclyl) aminocarbonyl: (alkyl) (heterocyclylalkyl) aminocarbonyl; (aralkyl) (heterocyclyl) aminocarbonyl; (aralkyl) (heterocyclylalkyl) aminocarbonyl; alkenoyl optionally substituted with aryl; alkenylsulfonyl optionally substituted with aryl; alkynoyl optionally substituted with aryl; alkynylsulfonyl optionally substituted with aryl; cycloalkenylcarbonyl; cycloalkenylsulfonyl; cycloalkylalkanoyl; cylcoalkylalkylsulfonyl; arylaroyl, biarylsulfonyl; alkoxysulfonyl; aralkoxysulfonyl; alkylaminosulfonyl; aryloxysulfonyl; arylaminosulfonyl;
    N-arylurea-substituted alkanoyl; N-arylurea-substituted alkylsulfonyl; cycloalkenylsubstituted carbonyl; cycloalkenyl-substituted sulfonyl; alkenoxycarbonyl optionally substituted with aryl; alkenoxysulfonyl optionally substituted with aryl; alkynoxycarbonyl optionally substituted with aryl; alkynoxysulfonyl optionally substituted with aryl; alkenyl- or alkynyl-aminocarbonyl optionally substituted with aryl; alkenylor alkynyl-aminosulfonyl optionally substituted with aryl; acylamino-substituted alkanoyl; acylamino-substituted alkylsulfonyl; aminocarbonyl-substituted alkanoyl; carbamoylsubstituted alkanoyl; carbamoyl-substituted alkylsulfonyl; heterocyclylalkanoyl; heterocyclylaminosulfonyl; carboxyalkylsubstituted aralkoyl; carboxyalkyl-substituted aralkylsulfonyl; oxocarbocyclyl-fused aroyl; oxocarbocyclyl-fused arylsulfonyl; heterocyclylalkanoyl;
    N=, N=-alkyl, arylhydrazinocarbonyl; aryloxy-substituted alkanoyl and heterocyclylalkylsuflonyl; alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, aryl-fused cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, aryl-substituted alkyl, aryl-substituted alkenyl or alkynyl, cycloalkyl-substituted alkyl, cycloalkenylsubstituted cylcoalkyl, biaryl, alkoxy, alkenoxy, alkynoxy, aryl-substituted alkoxy, aryl-substituted alkenoxy or alkynoxy, alkylamino, alkenylamino or alkynylamino, aryl-substituted alkylamino, aryl-substituted alkenylamino or alkynylamino, aryloxy, arylamino, N-alkylurea-substituted alkyl, N-arylureasubstituted alkyl, alkylcarbonylamino-substituted alkyl, aminocarbonyl-substituted alkyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylsubstituted alkyl, heterocyclyl-substituted amino, carboxyalkyl substituted aralkyl, oxocarbocyclyl-fused aryl and heterocyclylalkyl.
    11. The cell adhesion inhibitor according to claim 10, wherein A is selected from the group consisting of alkyl; aliphatic acyl optionally substituted with N-alkyl- or N-arylamido; aroyl; heterocycloyl; alkyl- and arylsulfonyl; aralkylcarbonyl optionally substituted with aryl; heterocycloalkylcarbonyl; alkoxycarbonyl; aralkyloxycarbonyl; cycloalkylcarbonyl optionally fused with aryl; heterocycloalkoxycarbonyl; alkylaminocarbonyl; arylaminocarbonyl and aralkylaminocarbonyl optionally substituted with bis-(alkylsulfonyl)amino, alkoxycarbonylamino or alkenyl.
    12. The cell adhesion inhibitor according to claim 11, wherein A is selected from the group consisting of aliphatic acyl, aroyl, aralkylcarbonyl, heterocycloyl, alkoxycarbonyl, aralkyloxycarbonyl and heterocycloalkylcarbonyl.
    13. The cell adhesion inhibitor according to claim 12, wherein A is selected from the group consisting of (N-Ar=-urea)-parasubstituted aralkylcarbonyl, (N-Ar=-urea)-para-substituted aralkyl and (N-Ar=-urea)-para-substituted aryl.
    14. The cell adhesion inhibitor according to claim 13, wherein A is selected from the group consisting of (N-Ar=-urea)-parasubstituted phenylmethylcarbonyl, (N-Ar=-urea)-para-substituted phenylmethyl and (N-Ar=-urea)-para-substituted phenyl.
    15. The cell adhesion inhibitor according to claim 14, wherein B is selected from the group consisting of formula IIa, Iib, and IIc EMI194.1 wherein A1 is selected from the group consisting of NR , O, S, (CR1R2) r and N[(CRÚRê)m(C=Y)AêRÚ]; A2 is selected from the group consisting of 0, NRê, S, and (CR1R2) r; A3 is selected from the group consisting NR1, O, S, and (CR1R2)r; X is selected from the group consisting of H2, 0, and S; Y is H2, or 0; r = 0, 1; n = 0-5;
    m = 1-4; W is selected from the group consisting of CO2H, SO3H, PO4H2, tetrazole, and H; Z is CO, or (CRÚRê)n; U is selected from the group consisting of COR12, (CRÚRê)nR12, and SO2R11; R1 and R2 are independently selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocycle; alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heterocycle, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, and carboxamide; R is RÚ, or amino acid side chains; R5 and R6 are independently selected from the group consisting of H, ORÚ, halogen, alkyl, SRÚ, NZR12, and NRÚRê; R11 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocycle;
    alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heterocycle, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, and carboxamide; and R12 is selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl.
    cycloalkenyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocycle; alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, heterocycle, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, carboxamide, and aralkoxy.
    16. The VLA-4 inhibitor according to claim 13, wherein: B is a structure selected from the group consisting of formula IIIa, formula IIIb and formula IIIc EMI196.1 wherein m=1-4; q = 1, 2; r = 0, 1; Y is H2, or 0; W is selected from the group consisting of CO2H, SO3H, PO4H2, tetrazole, and H; Z is CO, or (CR1R2) n; n = 0-5; R1 and R2 are independently selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocycle; alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heterocycle, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, and carboxamide; R is selected from the group consisting of H, aryl, substituted aryl, aralkyl, alkyl, alkenyl;
    alkyl optionally substituted with heterocycle, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, alkoxy, and halogen; R10 is selcted from the group consisting of Rê, NHSO2R11, NH2, ORê, and NHZR12; R12 is selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocycle; alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, heterocycle, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, carboxamide, and aralkoxy; R13 is H or -CH2(CH2)nCH2-; Rê and R7 may optionally be taken together to form -(CH2)m-; Rê and R10 may optionally be taken together to form -(CH2)m-; R11 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocycle;
    alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heterocycle, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, and carboxamide; Q is (CRÚRê)r, or NR12.
    17. The VLA-4 inhibitor according to claim 13, wherein: B is a structure selected from the group consisting of formula IVa, formula IVb and formula IVc EMI198.1 wherein A4 is selected from the group consisting of (CRÚRê)n, O, O, S, NRÚ,SO2NRÚ, CONRÚ, CH2NR11, NRÚSO2, CH2O, CH2NCOR11, and CH2CONRÚ; n = 0-5; m = 1-4; W is selected from the group consisting of CO2H, SO3H, PO4H2, tetrazole, and H; Z is CO, or (CRÚRê)n; 1 2 R1 and R2 are independently selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocycle;
    alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heterocycle, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, and carboxamide; R4 is selected from the group consisting of H, ORÚ, SRÚ, NRÚRê, alkyl, NZRÚ, NSO2R11, and CO2RÚ; R5 and R6 are independently selected from the group consisting of H, ORÚ, halogen, alkyl, and NRÚRê; and R11 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocycle; alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heterocycle, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, and carboxamide.
    17. The VLA-4 inhibitor according to claim 13, wherein: B is a structure of formula Va or Vb EMI199.1 where in A3 is selected from the group consisting of NR1, O, S, and (CR1R2) r ; A5 is selected from the group consisting of 5O2R11, COR7, and (CRÚRê)nR7; n = 0-5; m = 1-4; r = 0, 1; W is selected from the group consisting of CO2H, SO3H, PO4H2, tetrazole, and H; P is CO, or SO2; RÚ and Rê are independently selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocycle;
    alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heterocycle, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, and carboxamide; R7 is selected from the group consisting of H, aryl, substituted aryl, aralkyl, alkyl, alkenyl; alkyl optionally substituted with heterocycle, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxy carbonyl, alkoxy, and halogen; When R8 is H, then R9 is R7, or R9 and R9 can be taken together to form a proline, thioproline or pipecolinic ring; R11 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocycle; alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heterocycle, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, and carboxamide.
    19. A pharmaceutical composition comprising (a) the cell adhesion inhibitor of claim 1 or 2, in an amount effective for the prevention, inhibition or suppression of cell adhesion; and (b) a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
    20. A VLA-4 inhibitor according to claim 2 wherein said inhibitor has an ICso of about 1 pM to about 10 ZM, as measured by a VLA-4 direct binding assay.
    21. The VLA-4 inhibitor according to claim 20 wherein said inhibitor has an ICso of about lpM to about 100 nM.
    22. The VLA-4 inhibitor according to claim 21 wherein said inhibitor has an IC50 of about 1 pM to about 10 nM.
    23. A method of converting a first compound having IIb/IIIa inhibitory activity, said first compound comprising a IIb/IIIa specificity determinant, said specificity determinant comprising a phenylamidine moiety or basic functionality, and an integrin scaffold, to a second, different compound which is capable of interfering with VLA-4 cell adhesion in a mammal without significantly inhibiting IIb/IIIa based cell adhesion, said method comprising the steps of: a) identifying the phenylamidine moiety in the specificity determinant of said first compound, or, if none is present, converting the basic functionality in said specificity determinant to a phantom phenylamidine moiety by creating phantom bonds in the para orientation, and removing unneeded bonds;
    b) removing the phenylamidine moiety identified in step a) and replacing said moiety with a VLA-4 specificity determinant thereby creating the second compound.
    24. The method of claim 23 further comprising the step of inserting an additional group at the point of, or adjacent to said specificity determinant to confer desirable characteristics on said second compound.
    25. The method of claim 24 wherein said additional group is a methylene.
    26. The method of claim 24 further comprising the step of modifying the second compound to alter the VLA-4 activity of said compound.
    27. A method of making a pharmaceutical composition for the treatment of a condition associated with cell adhesion, said method comprising the steps of: a) providing a first compound having IIb/IIIa inhibitory activity, said first compound comprising (i) a IIb/IIIa specificity determinant, said specificity determinant comprising a phenylamidine moiety or a basic nitrogen functionality, and (ii) an integrin scaffold; b) removing said IIb/IIIa specificity determinant and replacing it with a VLA-4 specificity determinant, thereby creating a second compound having VLA-4 inhibitory activity; and c) combining said second compound with a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier to thereby make a pharmaceutical composition.
    28. A pharmaceutical composition obtained by the method of claim 29. The method of claim 27 further comprising the step of manufacturing said pharmaceutical composition in commercial quantities.
    30. A method of treating a cell adhesion associated condition in a mammal comprising the step of administering to said mammal a therapeutically effective amount of a compound having Formula (I) which is capable of interfering with VLA-4 activity A-B (I) wherein A is a VLA-4 specificity determininant which does not impart significant IIb/IIIa activity and B comprises an integrin scaffold.
    31. The method of treatment of claim 30 wherein B comprises an integrin scaffold derived from a compound having IIb/IIIa activity.
    32. The method of claim 31 wherein B is selected from the group consisting of the integrin scaffolds of the compounds in Table 2.
    33. The method of claim 31 wherein B is a compound selected from the group consisting of Formula IIa, Formula IIb, and Formula IIc EMI203.1 wherein AÚ is selected from the group consisting of NRÚ, O, S, (CRÚRê)r, and N[(CRÚRê)m(C=Y)AêRÚ]; Aê is selected from the group consisting of O, NRê, S, and (CR1R2)r; A3 is selected from the group consisting NR1, O, S, and (CR1R2)r,, X is selected from the group consisting of H2, 0, and S; Y is H2, or 0; r = 0, 1; n = 0-5; m = 1-4; W is selected from the group consisting of CO2H, SO3H, PO4H2, tetrazole, and H; Z is CO, or (CRÚRê)n; U is selected from the group consisting of COR12, (CRÚRê)nR12, and SO2R11; RÚ and Rê are independently selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocycle;
    alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heterocycle, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, and carboxamide; R3 is R1, or amino acid side chains; R5 and R6 are independently selected from the group consisting of H, ORÚ, halogen, alkyl, SRÚ, NZR12, and NRÚRê; R11 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocycle; alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heterocycle, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, and carboxamide; and R12 is selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocycle;
    alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, heterocycle, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, carboxamide, and aralkoxy.
    34. The method of claim 31 wherein B is a compound selected from the group consisting of Formula IIIa, IIIb and IIIc EMI205.1 where in m = 1-4; q = 1, 2; r = 0, 1; Y is H2, or O; W is selected from the group consisting of CO2H, SO3H, PO4H2, tetrazole, and H; Z is CO, or (CRÚRê)n; n = 0-5; RÚ and Rê are independently selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocycle; alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heterocycle, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, and carboxamide; R7 is selected from the group consisting of H, aryl, substituted aryl, aralkyl, alkyl, alkenyl;
    alkyl optionally substituted with heterocycle, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, alkoxy, and halogen; R10 is selected from the group consisting of Rê, NHSO2R11, NH2, ORê, and NHZR12; R12 is selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocycle; alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, heterocycle, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, carboxamide, and aralkoxy; R13 is H or -CH2(CH2)mCH2-; Rê and R7 may optionally be taken together to form -(CH2)m-; Rê and R10 may optionally be taken together to form -(CH2)m-; R11 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocycle;
    alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heterocycle, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, and carboxamide; Q is (CRÚRê)r, or NR12.
    35. The method of claim 31 wherein the inhibitor is selected from the group consisting of compounds in Table 3.
    36. The method of claim 31 wherein the compound is selected from the group consisting of the compounds in Table 1.
    37. The method of claim 31 wherein A is selected from the group consisting of alkyl; aliphatic acyl optionally substituted with N-alkyl- or N-arylamido; aroyl; heterocycloyl; alkyl- or arylsulfonyl; aralkylcarbonyl optionally substituted with aryl; heterocycloalkylcarbonyl; alkoxycarbonyl; aralkyloxycarbonyl; cycloalkylcarbonyl optionally fused with aryl; heterocycloalkoxycarbonyl; alkylaminocarbonyl; arylamino carbonyl and aralkylaminocarbonyl optionally substituted with bis (alkylsulfonyl) amino, alkoxycarbonylamino or alkenyl; alkylsulfonyl; aralkylsulfonyl; arylsulfonyl; cycloalkylsulfonyl optionally fused with aryl; heterocyclylsulfonyl; heterocyclylalkylsulfonyl; aralkoxycarbonyl; aryloxycarbonyl; cycloalkyloxycarbonyl; heterocyclyloxycarbonyl; heterocyclylalkoxycarbonyl;
    mono- or di-alkylaminocarbonyl optionally substituted with aryl; (alkyl) (aralkyl) aminocarbonyl; mono- or di-aralkylaminocarbonyl; mono- or diarylaminocarbonyl; (aryl) (alkyl) aminocarbonyl; mono- or dicycloalkylaminocarbonyl; heterocyclylaminocarbonyl; heterocyclylalkylaminocarbonyl; (alkyl) (heterocyclyl) aminocarbonyl: (alkyl) (heterocyclylalkyl) aminocarbonyl; (aralkyl) (heterocyclyl) aminocarbonyl;
    (aralkyl) (heterocyclylalkyl) aminocarbonyl; alkenoyl optionally substituted with aryl; alkenylsulfonyl optionally substituted with aryl; alkynoyl optionally substituted with aryl; alkynylsulfonyl optionally substituted with aryl; cycloalkenylcarbonyl; cycloalkenylsulfonyl; cycloalkylalkanoyl; cylcoalkylalkylsulfonyl; arylaroyl, biarylsulfonyl; alkoxysulfonyl; aralkoxysulfonyl; alkylaminosulfonyl; aryloxysulfonyl; arylaminosulfonyl; N-arylurea-substituted alkanoyl;
    N-arylurea-substituted alkylsulfonyl; cycloalkenylsubstituted carbonyl; cycloalkenyl-substituted sulfonyl; alkenoxycarbonyl optionally substituted with aryl; alkenoxysulfonyl optionally substituted with aryl; alkynoxycarbonyl optionally substituted with aryl; alkynoxysulfonyl optionally substituted with aryl; alkenyl- or alkynyl-aminocarbonyl optionally substituted with aryl; alkenylor alkynyl-aminosulfonyl optionally substituted with aryl; acylamino-substituted alkanoyl; acylamino-substituted alkylsulfonyl; aminocarbonyl-substituted alkanoyl; carbamoylsubstituted alkanoyl; carbamoyl-substituted alkylsulfonyl; heterocyclylalkanoyl; heterocyclylaminosulfonyl; carboxyalkylsubstituted aralkoyl; carboxyalkyl-substituted aralkylsulfonyl; oxocarbocyclyl-fused aroyl; oxocarbocyclyl-fused arylsulfonyl; heterocyclylalkanoyl;
    N', N'-alkyl, arylhydrazinocarbonyl; aryloxy-substituted alkanoyl and heterocyclylalkylsuflonyl; alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, aryl-fused cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, aryl-substituted alkyl ("aralkyl"), arylsubstituted alkenyl or alkynyl, cycloalkyl-substituted alkyl, cycloalkenyl-substituted cylcoalkyl, biaryl, alkoxy, alkenoxy, alkynoxy, aryl-substituted alkoxy ("aralkoxy"), aryl-substituted alkenoxy or alkynoxy, alkylamino, alkenylamino or alkynylamino, aryl-substituted alkylamino, aryl-substituted alkenylamino or alkynylamino, aryloxy, arylamino, N-alkylurea-substituted alkyl, N-arylurea-substituted alkyl, alkylcarbonylamino-substituted alkyl, aminocarbonyl-substituted alkyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclyl-substituted alkyl, heterocyclyl-substituted amino, carboxyalkyl substituted aralkyl, oxocarbocyclyl-fused aryl and heterocyclylalkyl.
    38. The method of claim 37, wherein A is selected from the group consisting of alkyl; aliphatic acyl optionally substituted with N-alkyl- or N-arylamido; aroyl; heterocycloyl; alkyl- and arylsulfonyl; aralkylcarbonyl optionally substituted with aryl; heterocycloalkylcarbonyl; alkoxycarbonyl; aralkyloxycarbonyl; cycloalkylcarbonyl optionally fused with aryl; heterocycloalkoxycarbonyl; alkylaminocarbonyl; arylaminocarbonyl and aralkylaminocarbonyl optionally substituted with bis (alkylsulfonyl) amino, alkoxycarbonylamino or alkenyl.
    39. The method of claim 38, wherein A is selected EMI210.1 where in A4 is selected from the group consisting of (CRÚRê)n, O, S, NRÚ,SO2NRÚ, CONRÚ, CH2NR11, NRÚSO2, CH2O, CH2NCOR11, and CH2CONRÚ; n = 0-5; m = 1-4; W is selected from the group consisting of CO2H, SO3H, PO4H2, tetrazole, and H; Z is CO, or (CRÚRê)n; RÚ and Rê are independently selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocycle; alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heterocycle, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, and carboxamide; R4 is selected from the group consisting of H, ORÚ, SRÚ, NRÚRê, alkyl, NZRÚ, NSO2R11, and CO2RÚ; R5 and R6 are independently selected from the group consisting of H, ORÚ, halogen, alkyl, and NRÚRê;
    and R11 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocycle; alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heterocycle, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, and carboxamide.
    43. The method of claim 31, wherein: B is a structure of formula Va or Vb EMI211.1 wherein A3 is selected from the group consisting of NR1, O, S, and (CR1R2) r; A5 is selected from the group consisting of SO2R11, COR?, and (CR1R2) R7; n = 0-5; m = 1-4; r = 0, 1; W is selected from the group consisting of CO2H, SO3H, PO4H2, tetrazole, and H; P is CO, or SO2; RÚ and Rê are independently selected from the group consisting of H, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocycle;
    alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heterocycle, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, and carboxamide; R7 is selected from the group consisting of H, aryl, substituted aryl, aralkyl, alkyl, alkenyl; alkyl optionally substituted with heterocycle, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxy carbonyl, alkoxy, and halogen; When R8 is H, then R9 is R7, or Ra and R9 can be taken together to form a 4-7 memeber ring optionally substituted with hydroxyl, ORÚ, -NÚRÚRê, -SRÚ, SO2R11, -SOR11; R11 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, aryl, aralkyl, heterocycle;
    alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heterocycle, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, and carboxamide.
    44. A IIb/IIIa inhibitor comprising a compound having Formula (Il) X-Y wherein X comprises a IIb/IIIa specificity determinant which does not impart significant VLA-4 activity, and Y comprises an integrin scaffold derived from a VLA-4 inhibitor.
    45. The IIb/IIIa inhibitor of claim 44 wherein Y comprises a peptoid of the formula EMI213.1 where A is any IIb/IIIa specificity determinant such as those exemplified in table-2.
    A3 is selected from the group consisting of NR1, O, S, and (CRÚRê)r; A5 is selected from the group consisting of SO2R11, COR7, and (CR1R2;R7' n = 0-5; m = 1-4; r = 0, 1; W is selected from the group consisting of CO2H, SO3H, PO4H2, tetrazole, and H; P is selected from the group consisting of CO, SO2; RÚ and Rê are independently selected from the group consisting of H; alkyl; alkenyl; alkynyl; cycloalkyl; cycloalkenyl; aryl; aralkyl; heterocycle; and alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heterocycle, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, or alkoxycarbonyl, carboxamide; R7 is selected from the group consisting of H; aryl; substituted aryl; aralkyl; alkyl; alkenyl;
    and alkyl optionally substituted with heterocycle, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxy carbonyl, alkoxy, or halogen; R15 and R16 are independently H or methyl; R11 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl; alkenyl; alkynyl; cycloalkyl; cycloalkenyl; aryl; aralkyl; heterocycle; and alkyl optionally substituted with cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, heterocycle, alkenyl, alkynyl, alkoxyl, hydroxyl, halogen, aralkoxy, thioalkoxy, carboxy, alkoxycarbonyl, or carboxamide.
    46. A method of making a IIb/IIIa inhibitor comprising the steps of: a) providing a VLA-4 inhibitor comprising a VLA-4 specificity determinant and an integrin scaffold; b) replacing said VLA-4 specificity determinant with a IIb/IIIa specificity determinant to thereby create a compound having IIb/IIIa inhibitory activity.
    47. The method of claim 46 wherein the integrin scaffold in step a) is a peptoid.
    48. A method of treating a condition associated with IIb/IIIa cell adhesion comprising administering to a mammal a composition comprising an effective amount of the inhibitor of claim 44.
    49. A pharmaceutical composition comprising the compound of claim 44 and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
    50. A cell adhesion inhibitor selected from the compounds in Table 1.
    51. A pharmaceutical composition comprising one or more inhibitors of claim 50 and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
    52. The method of claim 30 wherein said cell adhesion associated condition is asthma or adult respiratory distress syndrome.
    53. The method of claim 30 wherein said cell adhesion associated condition is multiple sclerosis.
    54. The method of claim 30 wherein siad cell adhesion associated condition is diabetes.
    55. The method of claim 30 wherein said cell adhesion associated condition is an inflammatory or autoimmune disease.
AU37386/97A 1996-07-25 1997-07-24 Cell adhesion inhibitors Ceased AU737372C (en)

Priority Applications (1)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
AU91330/01A AU759063B2 (en) 1996-07-25 2001-11-14 Cell adhesion inhibitors

Applications Claiming Priority (5)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US2289096P 1996-07-25 1996-07-25
US60/022890 1996-07-25
US3278696P 1996-12-06 1996-12-06
US60/032786 1996-12-06
PCT/US1997/013013 WO1998004247A1 (en) 1996-07-25 1997-07-24 Cell adhesion inhibitors

Related Child Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
AU91330/01A Division AU759063B2 (en) 1996-07-25 2001-11-14 Cell adhesion inhibitors

Publications (3)

Publication Number Publication Date
AU3738697A AU3738697A (en) 1998-02-20
AU737372B2 AU737372B2 (en) 2001-08-16
AU737372C true AU737372C (en) 2002-06-27

Family

ID=

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
CA2261848C (en) Cell adhesion inhibitors
AU780610B2 (en) Cell adhesion inhibitors
CZ5298A3 (en) Cell adhesion inhibitors
US6686350B1 (en) Cell adhesion inhibitors
AU737372C (en) Cell adhesion inhibitors
AU759063B2 (en) Cell adhesion inhibitors
HK1020262B (en) Cell adhesion inhibitors
HK1099708A (en) Cell adhesion inhibitors